Add support for defun in thingatpt.el
[emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
blobf87c22912a4b135e26547440450808a0b7312035
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
3 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993-2011 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
21 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
23 #include <config.h>
24 #include <signal.h>
25 #include <stdio.h>
26 #include <setjmp.h>
28 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
30 #include "lisp.h"
31 #include "blockinput.h"
33 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
34 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
35 #include "syssignal.h"
37 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
38 if this is not done before the other system files. */
39 #include "xterm.h"
40 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
42 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
43 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
44 #ifndef makedev
45 #include <sys/types.h>
46 #endif /* makedev */
48 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
50 #include "systime.h"
52 #include <fcntl.h>
53 #include <ctype.h>
54 #include <errno.h>
55 #include <setjmp.h>
56 #include <sys/stat.h>
57 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
58 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
60 #include "charset.h"
61 #include "character.h"
62 #include "coding.h"
63 #include "frame.h"
64 #include "dispextern.h"
65 #include "fontset.h"
66 #include "termhooks.h"
67 #include "termopts.h"
68 #include "termchar.h"
69 #include "emacs-icon.h"
70 #include "disptab.h"
71 #include "buffer.h"
72 #include "window.h"
73 #include "keyboard.h"
74 #include "intervals.h"
75 #include "process.h"
76 #include "atimer.h"
77 #include "keymap.h"
78 #include "font.h"
79 #include "fontset.h"
80 #include "xsettings.h"
81 #include "xgselect.h"
82 #include "sysselect.h"
84 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
85 #include <X11/Shell.h>
86 #endif
88 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
89 #include <sys/time.h>
90 #endif
92 #include <unistd.h>
94 #ifdef USE_GTK
95 #include "gtkutil.h"
96 #endif
98 #ifdef USE_LUCID
99 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
100 #endif
102 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
103 #if !defined(NO_EDITRES)
104 #define HACK_EDITRES
105 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
106 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
108 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
110 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
111 #if defined USE_MOTIF
112 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
113 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
114 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
116 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
117 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
118 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
119 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
120 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
121 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
122 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
123 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
124 #ifndef XtNpickTop
125 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
126 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
127 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
128 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
130 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
132 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
133 #include "widget.h"
134 #ifndef XtNinitialState
135 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
136 #endif
137 #endif
139 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
140 #ifdef USE_XIM
141 int use_xim = 1;
142 #else
143 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
144 #endif
148 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
149 start. */
151 static int any_help_event_p;
153 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
154 static Lisp_Object last_window;
156 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
157 use. */
159 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
161 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
162 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
163 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
164 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
166 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
168 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
169 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
170 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
171 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
173 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
175 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
177 static struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
179 /* This is a frame waiting for an event matching mask, within XTread_socket. */
181 static struct {
182 struct frame *f;
183 int eventtype;
184 } pending_event_wait;
186 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
187 /* The application context for Xt use. */
188 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
189 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
190 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
192 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
194 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
196 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
197 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
198 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
200 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
202 /* Mouse movement.
204 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
205 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
206 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
207 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
209 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
211 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
212 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
213 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
214 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
215 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
216 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
217 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
218 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
219 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
220 is off. */
222 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
224 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
225 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
226 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
228 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
230 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
231 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
232 an ordinary motion.
234 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
235 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
236 event. */
238 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
240 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
241 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
242 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
243 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
244 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
245 it's somewhat accurate. */
247 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
249 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
251 static Time last_user_time;
253 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
254 events. */
256 #ifdef __STDC__
257 static int volatile input_signal_count;
258 #else
259 static int input_signal_count;
260 #endif
262 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
264 static int x_noop_count;
266 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
268 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
269 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
271 #ifdef USE_GTK
272 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
273 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file;
275 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
276 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock;
277 #endif
279 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
280 static char emacs_class[] = EMACS_CLASS;
282 enum xembed_info
284 XEMBED_MAPPED = 1 << 0
287 enum xembed_message
289 XEMBED_EMBEDDED_NOTIFY = 0,
290 XEMBED_WINDOW_ACTIVATE = 1,
291 XEMBED_WINDOW_DEACTIVATE = 2,
292 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS = 3,
293 XEMBED_FOCUS_IN = 4,
294 XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT = 5,
295 XEMBED_FOCUS_NEXT = 6,
296 XEMBED_FOCUS_PREV = 7,
298 XEMBED_MODALITY_ON = 10,
299 XEMBED_MODALITY_OFF = 11,
300 XEMBED_REGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 12,
301 XEMBED_UNREGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 13,
302 XEMBED_ACTIVATE_ACCELERATOR = 14
305 /* Used in x_flush. */
307 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *, Colormap, XColor *);
308 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *, int, int, int);
309 static const XColor *x_color_cells (Display *, int *);
310 static void x_update_window_end (struct window *, int, int);
312 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display *);
313 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *);
314 void x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *);
315 static void x_update_end (struct frame *);
316 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *);
317 static void XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
318 static void XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
319 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame *);
320 static void x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *, int, int) NO_RETURN;
321 static void frame_highlight (struct frame *);
322 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame *);
323 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *, struct frame *);
324 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info *,
325 struct frame *, struct input_event *);
326 static void x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *,
327 XEvent *, struct input_event *);
328 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *);
329 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *);
330 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *);
331 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
332 enum text_cursor_kinds);
334 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC);
335 static void x_flush (struct frame *f);
336 static void x_update_begin (struct frame *);
337 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window *);
338 static void x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *);
339 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *, Window);
340 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
341 enum scroll_bar_part *,
342 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
343 unsigned long *);
344 static void x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *, XPropertyEvent *);
345 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *);
346 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame *, int, int);
347 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame *, int, int, int);
348 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
349 int *, struct input_event *);
350 /* Don't declare this NO_RETURN because we want no
351 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
352 static SIGTYPE x_connection_closed (Display *, const char *);
355 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
357 static void
358 x_flush (struct frame *f)
360 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
361 connection may be broken. */
362 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
363 return;
365 BLOCK_INPUT;
366 if (f == NULL)
368 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
369 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
370 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
371 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
373 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
374 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
375 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
379 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
380 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
381 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
382 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
383 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
384 performance. */
386 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
389 /***********************************************************************
390 Debugging
391 ***********************************************************************/
393 #if 0
395 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
396 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
398 struct record
400 char *locus;
401 int type;
404 struct record event_record[100];
406 int event_record_index;
408 void
409 record_event (char *locus, int type)
411 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
412 event_record_index = 0;
414 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
415 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
416 event_record_index++;
419 #endif /* 0 */
423 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
425 struct x_display_info *
426 x_display_info_for_display (Display *dpy)
428 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
430 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
431 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
432 return dpyinfo;
434 return 0;
437 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
439 void
440 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame *f)
442 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
443 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
444 Window win = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
445 double alpha = 1.0;
446 double alpha_min = 1.0;
447 unsigned long opac;
449 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window != FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc)
450 /* Since the WM decoration lies under the FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW,
451 we must treat the former instead of the latter. */
452 win = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
454 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame == f)
455 alpha = f->alpha[0];
456 else
457 alpha = f->alpha[1];
459 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
460 alpha_min = XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit);
461 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
462 alpha_min = (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit)) / 100.0;
464 if (alpha < 0.0)
465 return;
466 else if (alpha > 1.0)
467 alpha = 1.0;
468 else if (0.0 <= alpha && alpha < alpha_min && alpha_min <= 1.0)
469 alpha = alpha_min;
471 opac = alpha * OPAQUE;
473 /* return unless necessary */
475 unsigned char *data;
476 Atom actual;
477 int rc, format;
478 unsigned long n, left;
480 x_catch_errors (dpy);
481 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
482 0L, 1L, False, XA_CARDINAL,
483 &actual, &format, &n, &left,
484 &data);
486 if (rc == Success && actual != None)
488 unsigned long value = *(unsigned long *)data;
489 XFree ((void *) data);
490 if (value == opac)
492 x_uncatch_errors ();
493 return;
498 XChangeProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
499 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
500 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
501 x_uncatch_errors ();
505 x_display_pixel_height (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
507 return HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
511 x_display_pixel_width (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
513 return WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
517 /***********************************************************************
518 Starting and ending an update
519 ***********************************************************************/
521 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
522 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
523 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
524 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
525 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
527 static void
528 x_update_begin (struct frame *f)
530 /* Nothing to do. */
534 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
535 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
536 position of W. */
538 static void
539 x_update_window_begin (struct window *w)
541 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
542 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
544 updated_window = w;
545 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
547 BLOCK_INPUT;
549 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
551 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
552 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 1;
554 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
555 highlighting. */
556 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
557 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
560 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
564 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
566 static void
567 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window *w, int x, int y0, int y1)
569 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
570 struct face *face;
572 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
573 if (face)
574 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
575 face->foreground);
577 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
578 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
581 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
583 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
584 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
586 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
587 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
588 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
590 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
591 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
592 here. */
594 static void
595 x_update_window_end (struct window *w, int cursor_on_p, int mouse_face_overwritten_p)
597 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
599 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
601 BLOCK_INPUT;
603 if (cursor_on_p)
604 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
605 output_cursor.vpos,
606 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
608 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
609 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
611 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
614 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
615 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
616 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
618 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
619 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
620 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
623 updated_window = NULL;
627 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
628 update_end. */
630 static void
631 x_update_end (struct frame *f)
633 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
634 MOUSE_HL_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
636 #ifndef XFlush
637 BLOCK_INPUT;
638 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
639 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
640 #endif
644 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
645 complete update has been performed. The global variable
646 updated_window is not available here. */
648 static void
649 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *f)
651 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
653 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
655 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
656 || f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
658 BLOCK_INPUT;
659 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
660 note_mouse_highlight (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
661 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
662 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
663 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
664 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
670 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
671 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
672 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
673 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
674 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
675 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
677 static void
678 x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *desired_row)
680 struct window *w = updated_window;
681 struct frame *f;
682 int width, height;
684 xassert (w);
686 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
687 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
689 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
690 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
691 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
692 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
693 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
694 overhead is very small. */
695 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
696 && desired_row->full_width_p
697 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
698 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
699 width != 0)
700 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
701 height > 0))
703 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
705 BLOCK_INPUT;
706 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
707 0, y, width, height, False);
708 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
709 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
710 y, width, height, False);
711 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
715 static void
716 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p)
718 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
719 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
720 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
721 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
722 struct face *face = p->face;
724 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
725 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
727 if (!p->overlay_p)
729 int bx = p->bx, by = p->by, nx = p->nx, ny = p->ny;
731 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
732 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
733 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
734 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
735 if (face->stipple)
736 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
737 else
738 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
740 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
741 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
742 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
743 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
744 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
745 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
746 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
747 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
749 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
751 if (sb_width > 0)
753 int left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
754 int width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
755 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
757 if (bx < 0)
759 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
760 if (left + width == p->x)
761 bx = left + sb_width;
762 else if (p->x + p->wd == left)
763 bx = left;
764 if (bx >= 0)
766 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
768 nx = width - sb_width;
769 by = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
770 row->y));
771 ny = row->visible_height;
774 else
776 if (left + width == bx)
778 bx = left + sb_width;
779 nx += width - sb_width;
781 else if (bx + nx == left)
782 nx += width - sb_width;
786 #endif
787 if (bx >= 0 && nx > 0)
788 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc, bx, by, nx, ny);
790 if (!face->stipple)
791 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
794 if (p->which)
796 char *bits;
797 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
798 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
799 XGCValues gcv;
801 if (p->wd > 8)
802 bits = (char *) (p->bits + p->dh);
803 else
804 bits = (char *) p->bits + p->dh;
806 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
807 by the server. */
808 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
809 (p->cursor_p
810 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
811 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
812 : face->foreground),
813 face->background, depth);
815 if (p->overlay_p)
817 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
818 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
819 bits, p->wd, p->h,
820 1, 0, 1);
821 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
822 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
823 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
824 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
827 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
828 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
829 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
831 if (p->overlay_p)
833 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
834 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
835 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
839 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
844 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
845 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
846 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
847 rarely happens). */
849 static void
850 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
854 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
855 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
857 static void
858 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
863 /***********************************************************************
864 Glyph display
865 ***********************************************************************/
869 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *);
870 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *);
871 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *,
872 int);
873 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
874 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
875 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *);
876 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
877 static void x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *, int) NO_RETURN;
878 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *);
879 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *);
880 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
881 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
882 static int x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
883 unsigned long *, double, int);
884 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *, struct relief *,
885 double, int, unsigned long);
886 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *);
887 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
888 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *);
889 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
890 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *, Pixmap);
891 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *, int,
892 int, int, int);
893 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
894 int, int, int, int, int, int,
895 XRectangle *);
896 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
897 int, int, int, XRectangle *);
898 static void x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame *);
900 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
901 static void x_check_font (struct frame *, struct font *);
902 #endif
905 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
906 face. */
908 static void
909 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
911 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
912 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
913 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
914 && !s->cmp)
915 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
916 else
918 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
919 XGCValues xgcv;
920 unsigned long mask;
922 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
923 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
925 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
926 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
927 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
928 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
929 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
930 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
931 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
933 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
934 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
935 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
937 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
938 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
941 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
942 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
943 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
945 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
946 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
947 mask, &xgcv);
948 else
949 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
950 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
952 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
957 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
959 static void
960 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
962 int face_id;
963 struct face *face;
965 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
966 face_id = MOUSE_HL_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
967 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
968 if (face == NULL)
969 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
971 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
972 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
973 else
974 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
975 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
976 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
978 if (s->font == s->face->font)
979 s->gc = s->face->gc;
980 else
982 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
983 except for FONT. */
984 XGCValues xgcv;
985 unsigned long mask;
987 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
988 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
989 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
990 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
992 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
993 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
994 mask, &xgcv);
995 else
996 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
997 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
999 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1002 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1006 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1007 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1008 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1010 static INLINE void
1011 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1013 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1017 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1018 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1019 pattern. */
1021 static INLINE void
1022 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1024 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1026 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1028 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1029 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1031 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1033 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1034 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1036 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1038 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1039 s->stippled_p = 0;
1041 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1043 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1044 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1046 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1047 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1049 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1050 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1052 else
1054 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1055 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1058 /* GC must have been set. */
1059 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1063 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1064 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1066 static INLINE void
1067 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *s)
1069 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
1070 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
1072 if (n > 0)
1073 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, r, n, Unsorted);
1074 s->num_clips = n;
1078 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1079 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1080 the area of SRC. */
1082 static void
1083 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string *src, struct glyph_string *dst)
1085 XRectangle r;
1087 r.x = src->x;
1088 r.width = src->width;
1089 r.y = src->y;
1090 r.height = src->height;
1091 dst->clip[0] = r;
1092 dst->num_clips = 1;
1093 XSetClipRectangles (dst->display, dst->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1097 /* RIF:
1098 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1100 static void
1101 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *s)
1103 if (s->cmp == NULL
1104 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
1105 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
1107 struct font_metrics metrics;
1109 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1111 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1112 struct font *font = s->font;
1113 int i;
1115 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1116 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1117 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1119 else
1121 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1123 composition_gstring_width (gstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, &metrics);
1125 s->right_overhang = (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width
1126 ? metrics.rbearing - metrics.width : 0);
1127 s->left_overhang = metrics.lbearing < 0 ? - metrics.lbearing : 0;
1129 else if (s->cmp)
1131 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1132 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1137 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1139 static INLINE void
1140 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
1142 XGCValues xgcv;
1143 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1144 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1145 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1146 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1150 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1151 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1152 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1153 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1154 contains the first component of a composition. */
1156 static void
1157 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *s, int force_p)
1159 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1160 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1161 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1163 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1165 if (s->stippled_p)
1167 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1168 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1169 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1170 s->y + box_line_width,
1171 s->background_width,
1172 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1173 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1174 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1176 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1177 || s->font_not_found_p
1178 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1179 || force_p)
1181 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1182 s->background_width,
1183 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1184 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1190 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1192 static void
1193 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1195 int i, x;
1197 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1198 of S to the right of that box line. */
1199 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1200 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1201 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1202 else
1203 x = s->x;
1205 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1206 loaded. */
1207 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1209 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1211 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1212 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1213 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1214 s->height - 1);
1215 x += g->pixel_width;
1218 else
1220 struct font *font = s->font;
1221 int boff = font->baseline_offset;
1222 int y;
1224 if (font->vertical_centering)
1225 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, s->f) - boff;
1227 y = s->ybase - boff;
1228 if (s->for_overlaps
1229 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1230 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 0);
1231 else
1232 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 1);
1233 if (s->face->overstrike)
1234 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, 0);
1238 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1240 static void
1241 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1243 int i, j, x;
1244 struct font *font = s->font;
1246 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1247 of S to the right of that box line. */
1248 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1249 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1250 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1251 else
1252 x = s->x;
1254 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1255 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1256 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1257 this composition. */
1259 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1260 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1261 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1263 if (s->cmp_from == 0)
1264 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1265 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1267 else if (! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
1269 int y = s->ybase;
1271 for (i = 0, j = s->cmp_from; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1272 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1274 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1275 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1277 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, 0);
1278 if (s->face->overstrike)
1279 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, 0);
1282 else
1284 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1285 Lisp_Object glyph;
1286 int y = s->ybase;
1287 int width = 0;
1289 for (i = j = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
1291 glyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1292 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph)))
1293 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph);
1294 else
1296 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1298 if (j < i)
1300 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1301 if (s->face->overstrike)
1302 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1303 x += width;
1305 xoff = LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph);
1306 yoff = LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph);
1307 wadjust = LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph);
1308 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, 0);
1309 if (s->face->overstrike)
1310 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff + 1, y + yoff, 0);
1311 x += wadjust;
1312 j = i + 1;
1313 width = 0;
1316 if (j < i)
1318 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1319 if (s->face->overstrike)
1320 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1326 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S for glyphless characters. */
1328 static void
1329 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1331 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
1332 XChar2b char2b[8];
1333 int x, i, j;
1335 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1336 of S to the right of that box line. */
1337 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1338 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1339 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1340 else
1341 x = s->x;
1343 s->char2b = char2b;
1345 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, glyph++)
1347 char buf[7], *str = NULL;
1348 int len = glyph->u.glyphless.len;
1350 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
1352 if (len > 0
1353 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
1354 && (CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display))
1355 >= 1))
1357 Lisp_Object acronym
1358 = (! glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font
1359 ? CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display,
1360 glyph->u.glyphless.ch)
1361 : XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0]);
1362 if (STRINGP (acronym))
1363 str = SSDATA (acronym);
1366 else if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE)
1368 sprintf ((char *) buf, "%0*X",
1369 glyph->u.glyphless.ch < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6,
1370 glyph->u.glyphless.ch);
1371 str = buf;
1374 if (str)
1376 int upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
1377 unsigned code;
1379 /* It is assured that all LEN characters in STR is ASCII. */
1380 for (j = 0; j < len; j++)
1382 code = s->font->driver->encode_char (s->font, str[j]);
1383 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b + j, code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
1385 s->font->driver->draw (s, 0, upper_len,
1386 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff,
1387 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff,
1389 s->font->driver->draw (s, upper_len, len,
1390 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff,
1391 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff,
1394 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method != GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
1395 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1396 x, s->ybase - glyph->ascent,
1397 glyph->pixel_width - 1,
1398 glyph->ascent + glyph->descent - 1);
1399 x += glyph->pixel_width;
1403 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1405 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget (Widget);
1406 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1407 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *);
1408 static void cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1409 XrmValue *, Cardinal *);
1412 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1413 cannot be determined. */
1415 static struct frame *
1416 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget)
1418 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1419 Lisp_Object tail;
1420 struct frame *f;
1422 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1424 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1425 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1426 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1427 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1428 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1429 widget = XtParent (widget);
1431 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1432 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1433 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1434 if (FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1435 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1436 (FRAME_X_P (f)
1437 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1438 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1439 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1440 return f;
1442 abort ();
1446 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
1447 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
1448 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
1449 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
1452 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1454 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1455 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color);
1459 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1460 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1461 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1462 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1463 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1464 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1467 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Display *display, Colormap cmap,
1468 unsigned long *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1470 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1471 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1475 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1476 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1478 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1480 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1481 sizeof (Screen *)},
1482 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1483 sizeof (Colormap)}
1487 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1488 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1490 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1493 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1495 DPY is the display we are working on.
1497 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1498 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1499 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1500 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1502 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1503 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1505 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1506 we allocated the color or not.
1508 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1510 static Boolean
1511 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *dpy, XrmValue *args, Cardinal *nargs,
1512 XrmValue *from, XrmValue *to,
1513 XtPointer *closure_ret)
1515 Screen *screen;
1516 Colormap cmap;
1517 Pixel pixel;
1518 String color_name;
1519 XColor color;
1521 if (*nargs != 2)
1523 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1524 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1525 "XtToolkitError",
1526 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1527 return False;
1530 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1531 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1532 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1534 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1536 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1537 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1539 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1541 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1542 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1544 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1545 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1547 pixel = color.pixel;
1548 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1550 else
1552 String params[1];
1553 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1555 params[0] = color_name;
1556 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1557 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1558 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1559 params, &nparams);
1560 return False;
1563 if (to->addr != NULL)
1565 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1567 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1568 return False;
1571 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1573 else
1575 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1576 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1579 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1580 return True;
1584 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1585 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1586 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1588 APP is the application context in which we work.
1590 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1591 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1592 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1594 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1596 static void
1597 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app, XrmValuePtr to, XtPointer closure, XrmValuePtr args,
1598 Cardinal *nargs)
1600 if (*nargs != 2)
1602 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1603 "XtToolkitError",
1604 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1605 NULL, NULL);
1607 else if (closure != NULL)
1609 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1610 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1611 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1612 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1613 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1618 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1621 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1622 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1623 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1624 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1626 static const XColor *
1627 x_color_cells (Display *dpy, int *ncells)
1629 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1631 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1633 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1634 int i;
1636 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1637 = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1638 dpyinfo->color_cells
1639 = (XColor *) xmalloc (dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1640 * sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1642 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells; ++i)
1643 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1645 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1646 dpyinfo->color_cells, dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1649 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1650 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1654 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1655 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1657 void
1658 x_query_colors (struct frame *f, XColor *colors, int ncolors)
1660 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1662 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1664 int i;
1665 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1667 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1668 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1669 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1670 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1673 else
1674 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1678 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1679 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1681 void
1682 x_query_color (struct frame *f, XColor *color)
1684 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1688 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1689 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1690 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1691 allocated. */
1693 static int
1694 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1696 int rc;
1698 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1699 if (rc == 0)
1701 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1702 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1703 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1704 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1705 int nearest, i;
1706 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~ (unsigned long) 0;
1707 int ncells;
1708 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1710 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1712 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1713 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1714 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1715 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1717 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1719 nearest = i;
1720 nearest_delta = delta;
1724 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1725 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1726 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1727 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1729 else
1731 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1732 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1733 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1734 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1735 XColor *cached_color;
1737 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1738 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1739 (cached_color->red != color->red
1740 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1741 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1743 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1744 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1745 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1749 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1750 if (rc)
1751 register_color (color->pixel);
1752 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1754 return rc;
1758 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1759 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1760 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1761 allocated. */
1764 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame *f, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1766 gamma_correct (f, color);
1767 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1771 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1772 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1773 get color reference counts right. */
1775 unsigned long
1776 x_copy_color (struct frame *f, long unsigned int pixel)
1778 XColor color;
1780 color.pixel = pixel;
1781 BLOCK_INPUT;
1782 x_query_color (f, &color);
1783 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1784 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1785 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1786 register_color (pixel);
1787 #endif
1788 return color.pixel;
1792 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1793 boosted.
1795 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1796 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1797 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1798 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1799 use an additional additive factor.
1801 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1802 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1803 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1806 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1807 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1808 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1809 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1810 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1811 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1813 static int
1814 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *f, Display *display, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1816 XColor color, new;
1817 long bright;
1818 int success_p;
1820 /* Get RGB color values. */
1821 color.pixel = *pixel;
1822 x_query_color (f, &color);
1824 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1825 xassert (factor >= 0);
1826 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1827 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1828 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1830 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1831 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1833 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1834 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1835 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1836 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1837 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1839 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1840 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1841 /* The additive adjustment. */
1842 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1844 if (factor < 1)
1846 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1847 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1848 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1850 else
1852 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1853 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1854 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1858 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1859 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1860 if (success_p)
1862 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1864 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1865 delta to the RGB values. */
1866 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1868 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1869 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1870 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1871 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1873 else
1874 success_p = 1;
1875 *pixel = new.pixel;
1878 return success_p;
1882 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1883 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1884 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1885 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1886 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1887 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1889 static void
1890 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *f, struct relief *relief, double factor, int delta, long unsigned int default_pixel)
1892 XGCValues xgcv;
1893 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1894 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1895 unsigned long pixel;
1896 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1897 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1898 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1899 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1901 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1902 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1904 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1905 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1906 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1907 if (relief->gc
1908 && relief->allocated_p)
1910 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1911 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1914 /* Allocate new color. */
1915 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1916 pixel = background;
1917 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1918 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1920 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1921 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1924 if (relief->gc == 0)
1926 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1927 mask |= GCStipple;
1928 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1930 else
1931 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1935 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1937 static void
1938 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *s)
1940 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1941 unsigned long color;
1943 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1944 color = s->face->box_color;
1945 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1946 && s->img->pixmap
1947 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1948 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1949 else
1951 XGCValues xgcv;
1953 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1954 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1955 color = xgcv.background;
1958 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
1959 || color != di->relief_background)
1961 di->relief_background = color;
1962 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
1963 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1964 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
1965 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1970 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
1971 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
1972 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
1973 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
1974 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
1975 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
1976 when drawing. */
1978 static void
1979 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *f,
1980 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
1981 int raised_p, int top_p, int bot_p, int left_p, int right_p,
1982 XRectangle *clip_rect)
1984 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1985 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
1986 int i;
1987 GC gc;
1989 if (raised_p)
1990 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
1991 else
1992 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
1993 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
1995 /* This code is more complicated than it has to be, because of two
1996 minor hacks to make the boxes look nicer: (i) if width > 1, draw
1997 the outermost line using the black relief. (ii) Omit the four
1998 corner pixels. */
2000 /* Top. */
2001 if (top_p)
2003 if (width == 1)
2004 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2005 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2006 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2008 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2009 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2010 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2011 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2014 /* Left. */
2015 if (left_p)
2017 if (width == 1)
2018 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2020 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2021 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2023 for (i = (width > 1 ? 1 : 0); i < width; ++i)
2024 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2025 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2028 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2029 if (raised_p)
2030 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2031 else
2032 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2033 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2035 if (width > 1)
2037 /* Outermost top line. */
2038 if (top_p)
2039 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2040 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2041 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2043 /* Outermost left line. */
2044 if (left_p)
2045 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2048 /* Bottom. */
2049 if (bot_p)
2051 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2052 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), bottom_y,
2053 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), bottom_y);
2054 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2055 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2056 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2057 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2060 /* Right. */
2061 if (right_p)
2063 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2064 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2065 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2066 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2067 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2070 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2074 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2075 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2076 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2077 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2078 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2079 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2081 static void
2082 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *s,
2083 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2084 int left_p, int right_p, XRectangle *clip_rect)
2086 XGCValues xgcv;
2088 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2089 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2090 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2092 /* Top. */
2093 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2094 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2096 /* Left. */
2097 if (left_p)
2098 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2099 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2101 /* Bottom. */
2102 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2103 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2105 /* Right. */
2106 if (right_p)
2107 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2108 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2110 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2111 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2115 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2117 static void
2118 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *s)
2120 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2121 int left_p, right_p;
2122 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2123 XRectangle clip_rect;
2125 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2126 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2127 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2129 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2130 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2131 ? s->first_glyph
2132 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2134 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2135 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2136 left_x = s->x;
2137 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2138 ? last_x - 1
2139 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2140 top_y = s->y;
2141 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2143 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2144 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2145 && (s->prev == NULL
2146 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2147 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2148 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2149 && (s->next == NULL
2150 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2152 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2154 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2155 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2156 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2157 else
2159 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2160 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2161 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2166 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2168 static void
2169 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
2171 int x = s->x;
2172 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2174 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2175 right of that line. */
2176 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2177 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2178 && s->slice.x == 0)
2179 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2181 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2182 by that margin. */
2183 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2184 x += s->img->hmargin;
2185 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2186 y += s->img->vmargin;
2188 if (s->img->pixmap)
2190 if (s->img->mask)
2192 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2193 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2194 trust on the shape extension to be available
2195 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2196 manually. */
2197 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2198 | GCFunction);
2199 XGCValues xgcv;
2200 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2202 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2203 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2204 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2205 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2206 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2208 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2209 image_rect.x = x;
2210 image_rect.y = y;
2211 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2212 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2213 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2214 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2215 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2216 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2218 else
2220 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2222 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2223 image_rect.x = x;
2224 image_rect.y = y;
2225 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2226 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2227 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2228 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2229 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2230 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2232 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2233 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2234 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2235 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2236 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2237 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2238 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2240 int relief = s->img->relief;
2241 if (relief < 0) relief = -relief;
2242 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2243 x - relief, y - relief,
2244 s->slice.width + relief*2 - 1,
2245 s->slice.height + relief*2 - 1);
2249 else
2250 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2251 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2252 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2256 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2258 static void
2259 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *s)
2261 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p, extra;
2262 XRectangle r;
2263 int x = s->x;
2264 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2266 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2267 right of that line. */
2268 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2269 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2270 && s->slice.x == 0)
2271 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2273 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2274 by that margin. */
2275 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2276 x += s->img->hmargin;
2277 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2278 y += s->img->vmargin;
2280 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2281 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2283 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2284 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2286 else
2288 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
2289 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2292 extra = s->face->id == TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID
2293 ? XINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin) : 0;
2295 x0 = x - thick - extra;
2296 y0 = y - thick - extra;
2297 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1 + extra;
2298 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1 + extra;
2300 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2301 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2302 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2303 s->slice.y == 0,
2304 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2305 s->slice.x == 0,
2306 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2307 &r);
2311 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2313 static void
2314 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *s, Pixmap pixmap)
2316 int x = 0;
2317 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2319 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2320 right of that line. */
2321 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2322 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2323 && s->slice.x == 0)
2324 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2326 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2327 by that margin. */
2328 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2329 x += s->img->hmargin;
2330 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2331 y += s->img->vmargin;
2333 if (s->img->pixmap)
2335 if (s->img->mask)
2337 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2338 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2339 trust on the shape extension to be available
2340 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2341 manually. */
2342 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2343 | GCFunction);
2344 XGCValues xgcv;
2346 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2347 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2348 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2349 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2350 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2352 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2353 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2354 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2355 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2357 else
2359 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2360 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2361 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2363 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2364 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2365 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2366 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2367 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2368 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2369 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2371 int r = s->img->relief;
2372 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2373 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2374 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2375 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2379 else
2380 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2381 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2382 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2386 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2387 give the rectangle to draw. */
2389 static void
2390 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
2392 if (s->stippled_p)
2394 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2395 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2396 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2397 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2399 else
2400 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2404 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2406 s->y
2407 s->x +-------------------------
2408 | s->face->box
2410 | +-------------------------
2411 | | s->img->margin
2413 | | +-------------------
2414 | | | the image
2418 static void
2419 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2421 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2422 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2423 int height;
2424 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2426 height = s->height;
2427 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2428 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2429 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2430 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2432 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2433 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2434 flickering. */
2435 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2436 if (height > s->slice.height
2437 || s->img->hmargin
2438 || s->img->vmargin
2439 || s->img->mask
2440 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2441 || s->width != s->background_width)
2443 if (s->img->mask)
2445 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2446 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2447 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2448 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2449 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2451 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2452 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2453 s->background_width,
2454 s->height, depth);
2456 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2457 pixmap. */
2458 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2460 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2461 if (s->stippled_p)
2463 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2464 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2465 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2466 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2467 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2468 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2469 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2471 else
2473 XGCValues xgcv;
2474 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2475 &xgcv);
2476 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2477 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2478 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2479 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2482 else
2484 int x = s->x;
2485 int y = s->y;
2487 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2488 && s->slice.x == 0)
2489 x += box_line_hwidth;
2491 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2492 y += box_line_vwidth;
2494 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2497 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2500 /* Draw the foreground. */
2501 if (pixmap != None)
2503 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2504 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2505 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2506 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2507 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2509 else
2510 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2512 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2513 if (s->img->relief
2514 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2515 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2516 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2520 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2522 static void
2523 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2525 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2527 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2528 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2530 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2531 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2532 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2533 int x = s->x;
2535 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2537 int left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2539 if (x < left_x)
2541 background_width -= left_x - x;
2542 x = left_x;
2545 else
2547 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2548 stretch glyph. */
2549 int right_x = window_box_right_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2551 if (x + background_width > right_x)
2552 background_width -= x - right_x;
2553 x += background_width;
2555 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2556 if (s->row->reversed_p)
2557 x -= width;
2559 /* Draw cursor. */
2560 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2562 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2563 if (width < background_width)
2565 int y = s->y;
2566 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2567 XRectangle r;
2568 GC gc;
2570 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2571 x += width;
2572 else
2573 x = s->x;
2574 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2575 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2577 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2578 gc = s->gc;
2580 else
2581 gc = s->face->gc;
2583 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2584 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2586 if (s->face->stipple)
2588 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2589 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2590 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2591 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2593 else
2595 XGCValues xgcv;
2596 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2597 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2598 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2599 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2603 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2605 int background_width = s->background_width;
2606 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2608 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2609 except for header line and mode line. */
2610 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2612 background_width -= left_x - x;
2613 x = left_x;
2615 if (background_width > 0)
2616 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2619 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2623 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2625 static void
2626 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2628 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2630 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2631 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2632 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2633 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2635 int width;
2636 struct glyph_string *next;
2638 for (width = 0, next = s->next;
2639 next && width < s->right_overhang;
2640 width += next->width, next = next->next)
2641 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
2643 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2644 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
2645 if (next->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
2646 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next);
2647 else
2648 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, 1);
2649 next->num_clips = 0;
2653 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2654 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2656 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2657 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2658 if (!s->for_overlaps
2659 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2660 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2661 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2664 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2665 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2666 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2667 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2668 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2670 else if (!s->clip_head /* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2671 && !s->clip_tail
2672 && ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
2673 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang)))
2674 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2675 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2676 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2677 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
2678 else
2679 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2681 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2683 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2684 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2685 break;
2687 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2688 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2689 break;
2691 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2692 if (s->for_overlaps)
2693 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2694 else
2695 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2696 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2697 break;
2699 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2700 if (s->for_overlaps || (s->cmp_from > 0
2701 && ! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic))
2702 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2703 else
2704 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2705 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2706 break;
2708 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH:
2709 if (s->for_overlaps)
2710 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2711 else
2712 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2713 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2714 break;
2716 default:
2717 abort ();
2720 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2722 /* Draw underline. */
2723 if (s->face->underline_p)
2725 unsigned long thickness, position;
2726 int y;
2728 if (s->prev && s->prev->face->underline_p)
2730 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2731 thickness = s->prev->underline_thickness;
2732 position = s->prev->underline_position;
2734 else
2736 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2737 if (s->font && s->font->underline_thickness > 0)
2738 thickness = s->font->underline_thickness;
2739 else
2740 thickness = 1;
2741 if (x_underline_at_descent_line)
2742 position = (s->height - thickness) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2743 else
2745 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2746 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2747 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2748 specs, and its default is
2750 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2751 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2753 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2754 && s->font && s->font->underline_position >= 0)
2755 position = s->font->underline_position;
2756 else if (s->font)
2757 position = (s->font->descent + 1) / 2;
2758 else
2759 position = underline_minimum_offset;
2761 position = max (position, underline_minimum_offset);
2763 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2764 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2765 if (s->y + s->height <= s->ybase + position)
2766 position = (s->height - 1) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2767 if (s->y + s->height < s->ybase + position + thickness)
2768 thickness = (s->y + s->height) - (s->ybase + position);
2769 s->underline_thickness = thickness;
2770 s->underline_position = position;
2771 y = s->ybase + position;
2772 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2773 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2774 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2775 else
2777 XGCValues xgcv;
2778 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2779 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2780 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2781 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2782 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2786 /* Draw overline. */
2787 if (s->face->overline_p)
2789 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2791 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2792 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2793 s->width, h);
2794 else
2796 XGCValues xgcv;
2797 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2798 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2799 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2800 s->width, h);
2801 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2805 /* Draw strike-through. */
2806 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2808 unsigned long h = 1;
2809 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2811 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2812 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2813 s->width, h);
2814 else
2816 XGCValues xgcv;
2817 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2818 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2819 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2820 s->width, h);
2821 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2825 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2826 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2827 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2829 if (s->prev)
2831 struct glyph_string *prev;
2833 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
2834 if (prev->hl != s->hl
2835 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
2837 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2838 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2839 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
2841 prev->hl = s->hl;
2842 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
2843 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
2844 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2845 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2846 else
2847 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2848 XSetClipMask (prev->display, prev->gc, None);
2849 prev->hl = save;
2850 prev->num_clips = 0;
2854 if (s->next)
2856 struct glyph_string *next;
2858 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
2859 if (next->hl != s->hl
2860 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
2862 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2863 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2864 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
2866 next->hl = s->hl;
2867 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2868 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
2869 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2870 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2871 else
2872 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2873 XSetClipMask (next->display, next->gc, None);
2874 next->hl = save;
2875 next->num_clips = 0;
2880 /* Reset clipping. */
2881 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2882 s->num_clips = 0;
2885 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2887 static void
2888 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height, int shift_by)
2890 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2891 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2892 x, y, width, height,
2893 x + shift_by, y);
2896 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2897 for X frames. */
2899 static void
2900 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *f, register int n)
2902 abort ();
2906 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2907 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2909 void
2910 x_clear_area (Display *dpy, Window window, int x, int y, int width, int height, int exposures)
2912 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2913 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2917 /* Clear an entire frame. */
2919 static void
2920 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
2922 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2923 longer visible. */
2924 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2925 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
2926 output_cursor.x = -1;
2928 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2929 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2930 BLOCK_INPUT;
2932 /* The following calls have been commented out because they do not
2933 seem to accomplish anything, apart from causing flickering during
2934 window resize. */
2935 /* XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f)); */
2937 /* We have to clear the scroll bars. If we have changed colors or
2938 something like that, then they should be notified. */
2939 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2941 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
2942 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
2943 redisplay, do it here. */
2944 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
2945 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
2946 #endif
2948 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2950 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2955 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2957 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2958 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
2960 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2963 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
2964 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
2966 static int
2967 timeval_subtract (struct timeval *result, struct timeval x, struct timeval y)
2969 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
2970 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
2971 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
2973 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
2974 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
2975 y.tv_sec += nsec;
2978 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
2980 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
2981 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
2982 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
2985 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
2986 positive. */
2987 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
2988 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
2990 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
2991 negative. */
2992 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
2995 static void
2996 XTflash (struct frame *f)
2998 BLOCK_INPUT;
3001 #ifdef USE_GTK
3002 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
3003 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
3004 GdkWindow *window = gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3005 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3006 cairo_t *cr = gdk_cairo_create (window);
3007 cairo_set_source_rgb (cr, 1, 1, 1);
3008 cairo_set_operator (cr, CAIRO_OPERATOR_DIFFERENCE);
3009 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3010 do { \
3011 cairo_rectangle (cr, x, y, w, h); \
3012 cairo_fill (cr); \
3014 while (0)
3015 #else /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3016 GdkGCValues vals;
3017 GdkGC *gc;
3018 vals.foreground.pixel = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3019 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3020 vals.function = GDK_XOR;
3021 gc = gdk_gc_new_with_values (window,
3022 &vals, GDK_GC_FUNCTION | GDK_GC_FOREGROUND);
3023 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3024 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
3025 #endif /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3026 #else /* ! USE_GTK */
3027 GC gc;
3029 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3030 pixels into background pixels. */
3032 XGCValues values;
3034 values.function = GXxor;
3035 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3036 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3038 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3039 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
3041 #endif
3043 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3044 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
3045 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3046 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
3047 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3048 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3049 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3051 int width;
3053 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
3054 edge it is next to. */
3055 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
3057 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
3058 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3059 break;
3061 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
3062 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3063 break;
3065 default:
3066 break;
3069 width = flash_right - flash_left;
3071 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3072 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3074 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3075 flash_left,
3076 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3077 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3078 width, flash_height);
3079 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3080 flash_left,
3081 (height - flash_height
3082 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3083 width, flash_height);
3086 else
3087 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3088 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3089 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3090 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3092 x_flush (f);
3095 struct timeval wakeup;
3097 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
3099 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
3100 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
3101 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
3102 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
3104 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3105 available. */
3106 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3108 struct timeval current;
3109 struct timeval timeout;
3111 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
3113 /* Break if result would be negative. */
3114 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
3115 break;
3117 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3118 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
3119 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
3121 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3122 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
3126 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3127 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3129 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3130 flash_left,
3131 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3132 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3133 width, flash_height);
3134 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3135 flash_left,
3136 (height - flash_height
3137 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3138 width, flash_height);
3140 else
3141 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3142 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3143 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3144 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3146 #ifdef USE_GTK
3147 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3148 cairo_destroy (cr);
3149 #else
3150 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc));
3151 #endif
3152 #undef XFillRectangle
3153 #else
3154 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3155 #endif
3156 x_flush (f);
3160 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3163 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
3166 static void
3167 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (FRAME_PTR f, int invisible)
3169 BLOCK_INPUT;
3170 if (invisible)
3172 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor != 0)
3173 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3174 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor);
3176 else
3177 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3178 f->output_data.x->current_cursor);
3179 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
3180 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3184 /* Make audible bell. */
3186 static void
3187 XTring_bell (struct frame *f)
3189 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3191 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3192 if (visible_bell)
3193 XTflash (f);
3194 else
3195 #endif
3197 BLOCK_INPUT;
3198 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3199 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3200 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3206 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3207 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3208 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3209 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3211 static void
3212 XTset_terminal_window (struct frame *f, int n)
3214 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3219 /***********************************************************************
3220 Line Dance
3221 ***********************************************************************/
3223 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3224 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3226 static void
3227 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *f, int vpos, int n)
3229 abort ();
3233 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3235 static void
3236 x_scroll_run (struct window *w, struct run *run)
3238 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3239 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3241 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3242 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3243 fringe of W. */
3244 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3246 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3247 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3248 bottom_y = y + height;
3250 if (to_y < from_y)
3252 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3253 line at the bottom. */
3254 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3255 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3256 else
3257 height = run->height;
3259 else
3261 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3262 at the bottom. */
3263 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3264 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3265 else
3266 height = run->height;
3269 BLOCK_INPUT;
3271 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3272 updated_window = w;
3273 x_clear_cursor (w);
3275 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3276 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3277 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3278 x, from_y,
3279 width, height,
3280 x, to_y);
3282 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3287 /***********************************************************************
3288 Exposure Events
3289 ***********************************************************************/
3292 static void
3293 frame_highlight (struct frame *f)
3295 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3296 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3297 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3298 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3299 BLOCK_INPUT;
3300 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3301 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3302 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3303 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3304 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3307 static void
3308 frame_unhighlight (struct frame *f)
3310 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3311 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3312 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3313 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3314 BLOCK_INPUT;
3315 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3316 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3317 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3318 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3319 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3322 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3323 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3324 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3325 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3326 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3328 static void
3329 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame)
3331 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3333 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3335 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3336 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3337 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3339 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3340 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3342 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3343 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3344 else
3345 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3348 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3351 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3352 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3353 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3355 static void
3356 x_focus_changed (int type, int state, struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame, struct input_event *bufp)
3358 if (type == FocusIn)
3360 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3362 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3363 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3365 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3366 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3367 if (NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3368 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
3369 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3371 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3372 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3376 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3378 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3379 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3380 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3381 #endif
3383 else if (type == FocusOut)
3385 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3387 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3389 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3390 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3393 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3394 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3395 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3396 #endif
3397 if (frame->pointer_invisible)
3398 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame, 0);
3402 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3403 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3405 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3407 static void
3408 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event, struct input_event *bufp)
3410 struct frame *frame;
3412 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3413 if (! frame)
3414 return;
3416 switch (event->type)
3418 case EnterNotify:
3419 case LeaveNotify:
3421 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3422 int focus_state
3423 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3425 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3426 && event->xcrossing.focus
3427 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3428 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3429 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3430 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3432 break;
3434 case FocusIn:
3435 case FocusOut:
3436 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3437 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3438 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3439 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3440 break;
3442 case ClientMessage:
3443 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
3445 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
3446 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3447 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3449 break;
3454 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3456 void
3457 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3459 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3462 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3463 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3464 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3466 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3467 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3468 the appropriate X display info. */
3470 static void
3471 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *frame)
3473 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3476 static void
3477 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3479 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3481 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3483 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3484 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3485 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3486 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3487 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3489 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3490 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3493 else
3494 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3496 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3498 if (old_highlight)
3499 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3500 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3501 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3507 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3509 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3510 static void
3511 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3513 int min_code, max_code;
3514 KeySym *syms;
3515 int syms_per_code;
3516 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3518 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3519 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3520 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3521 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3522 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3524 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3526 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3527 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3528 &syms_per_code);
3529 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3531 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3532 Alt keysyms are on. */
3534 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3535 int found_alt_or_meta;
3537 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3539 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3540 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3542 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3544 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3545 if (code == 0)
3546 continue;
3548 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3550 int code_col;
3552 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3554 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3556 switch (sym)
3558 case XK_Meta_L:
3559 case XK_Meta_R:
3560 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3561 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3562 break;
3564 case XK_Alt_L:
3565 case XK_Alt_R:
3566 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3567 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3568 break;
3570 case XK_Hyper_L:
3571 case XK_Hyper_R:
3572 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3573 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3574 code_col = syms_per_code;
3575 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3576 break;
3578 case XK_Super_L:
3579 case XK_Super_R:
3580 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3581 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3582 code_col = syms_per_code;
3583 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3584 break;
3586 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3587 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3588 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3589 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3590 code_col = syms_per_code;
3591 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3592 break;
3600 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3601 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3603 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3604 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3607 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3608 make them just meta, not alt. */
3609 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3611 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3614 XFree ((char *) syms);
3615 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3618 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3619 Emacs uses. */
3621 unsigned int
3622 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, unsigned int state)
3624 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3625 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3626 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3627 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3628 Lisp_Object tem;
3630 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3631 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3632 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3633 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3634 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3635 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3636 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3637 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3640 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3641 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3642 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3643 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3644 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3645 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3648 static unsigned int
3649 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, unsigned int state)
3651 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3652 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3653 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3654 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3656 Lisp_Object tem;
3658 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3659 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3660 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3661 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3662 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3663 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3664 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3665 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3668 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3669 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3670 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3671 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3672 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3673 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3676 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3678 char *
3679 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym)
3681 char *value;
3683 BLOCK_INPUT;
3684 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3685 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3687 return value;
3692 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3694 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3696 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3697 the mouse. */
3699 static Lisp_Object
3700 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event *result, XButtonEvent *event, struct frame *f)
3702 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3703 otherwise. */
3704 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3705 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3706 result->timestamp = event->time;
3707 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3708 event->state)
3709 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3710 ? up_modifier
3711 : down_modifier));
3713 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3714 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3715 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3716 result->arg = Qnil;
3717 return Qnil;
3721 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3722 The input handler calls this.
3724 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3725 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3726 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3727 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3729 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3730 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3732 static int
3733 note_mouse_movement (FRAME_PTR frame, XMotionEvent *event)
3735 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3736 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3737 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3739 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3740 return 0;
3742 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3744 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3745 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3746 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3747 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3748 return 1;
3752 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3753 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3754 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3755 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3756 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3757 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3759 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3760 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3761 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3762 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3763 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3764 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3765 return 1;
3768 return 0;
3772 /************************************************************************
3773 Mouse Face
3774 ************************************************************************/
3776 static void
3777 redo_mouse_highlight (void)
3779 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3780 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3781 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3782 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3783 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3788 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3789 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3791 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3792 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3793 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3794 position on the scroll bar.
3796 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3797 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3798 the mouse is over.
3800 Set *TIMESTAMP to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3801 was at this position.
3803 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3805 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3806 movement. */
3808 static void
3809 XTmouse_position (FRAME_PTR *fp, int insist, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
3810 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y,
3811 long unsigned int *timestamp)
3813 FRAME_PTR f1;
3815 BLOCK_INPUT;
3817 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3818 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, timestamp);
3819 else
3821 Window root;
3822 int root_x, root_y;
3824 Window dummy_window;
3825 int dummy;
3827 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3829 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3830 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3831 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
3832 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3833 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3835 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3837 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3838 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3839 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3841 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3842 &root,
3844 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3845 a different screen. */
3846 &dummy_window,
3848 /* The position on that root window. */
3849 &root_x, &root_y,
3851 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3852 &dummy, &dummy,
3854 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3855 we don't care. */
3856 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3858 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3859 containing the pointer. */
3861 Window win, child;
3862 int win_x, win_y;
3863 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3865 win = root;
3867 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3868 structure is changing at the same time this function
3869 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3871 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3873 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3874 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3876 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3877 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3878 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3880 /* From-window, to-window. */
3881 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3883 /* From-position, to-position. */
3884 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3886 /* Child of win. */
3887 &child);
3888 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3890 else
3892 while (1)
3894 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3896 /* From-window, to-window. */
3897 root, win,
3899 /* From-position, to-position. */
3900 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3902 /* Child of win. */
3903 &child);
3905 if (child == None || child == win)
3906 break;
3907 #ifdef USE_GTK
3908 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3909 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
3910 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
3911 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
3912 if (x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win))
3913 break;
3914 #endif
3915 win = child;
3916 parent_x = win_x;
3917 parent_y = win_y;
3920 /* Now we know that:
3921 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3922 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3923 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3924 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3925 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3926 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3927 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3928 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3929 never use them in that case.) */
3931 #ifdef USE_GTK
3932 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3933 want the edit window. */
3934 f1 = x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3935 #else
3936 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3937 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3938 #endif
3940 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3941 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
3942 on the frame. */
3943 if (f1 != NULL
3944 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
3945 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
3946 f1 = NULL;
3947 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3950 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
3951 f1 = 0;
3953 x_uncatch_errors ();
3955 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
3956 if (! f1)
3958 struct scroll_bar *bar;
3960 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
3962 if (bar)
3964 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
3965 win_x = parent_x;
3966 win_y = parent_y;
3970 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
3971 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3973 if (f1)
3975 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
3976 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
3977 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
3978 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
3979 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
3980 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
3981 the frame are divided into. */
3983 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3984 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
3986 *bar_window = Qnil;
3987 *part = 0;
3988 *fp = f1;
3989 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
3990 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
3991 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
3996 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4001 /***********************************************************************
4002 Scroll bars
4003 ***********************************************************************/
4005 /* Scroll bar support. */
4007 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4008 manages it.
4009 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4010 bits. */
4012 static struct scroll_bar *
4013 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *display, Window window_id)
4015 Lisp_Object tail;
4017 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4018 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
4019 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4021 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4023 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
4025 frame = XCAR (tail);
4026 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
4027 if (! FRAMEP (frame))
4028 abort ();
4030 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4031 continue;
4033 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4034 right window ID. */
4035 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4036 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4037 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4038 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4039 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
4040 condemned = Qnil,
4041 ! NILP (bar));
4042 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
4043 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id &&
4044 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
4045 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
4048 return 0;
4052 #if defined USE_LUCID
4054 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4055 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4057 static Widget
4058 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window)
4060 Lisp_Object tail;
4062 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4064 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (XCAR (tail))))
4066 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
4067 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
4069 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
4070 return menu_bar;
4074 return NULL;
4077 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4080 /************************************************************************
4081 Toolkit scroll bars
4082 ************************************************************************/
4084 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4086 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *, struct input_event *);
4087 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object, int, int, int);
4088 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *,
4089 struct scroll_bar *);
4090 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *,
4091 int, int, int);
4094 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4095 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4097 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4099 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4101 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4103 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4104 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4106 #ifndef USE_GTK
4107 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4109 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4111 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4113 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4114 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4115 to avoid jerkyness. */
4117 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4119 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4120 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4121 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4122 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4124 static void
4125 xt_action_hook (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, String action_name,
4126 XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params)
4128 int scroll_bar_p;
4129 const char *end_action;
4131 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4132 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4133 end_action = "Release";
4134 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4135 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4136 end_action = "EndScroll";
4137 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4139 if (scroll_bar_p
4140 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4141 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4143 struct window *w;
4145 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4146 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4147 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4149 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4151 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4152 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4153 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4155 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4156 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4158 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4159 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4162 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4164 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4165 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4167 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4168 static int scroll_bar_windows_size;
4171 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4172 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4173 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4174 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4176 static void
4177 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window, int part, int portion, int whole)
4179 XEvent event;
4180 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4181 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4182 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4183 int i;
4185 BLOCK_INPUT;
4187 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4188 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4189 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4190 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4191 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4192 ev->format = 32;
4194 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4195 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4196 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4197 into that array in the event. */
4198 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4199 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4200 break;
4202 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4204 int new_size = max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size);
4205 size_t nbytes = new_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4206 size_t old_nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4208 scroll_bar_windows = (struct window **) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows,
4209 nbytes);
4210 memset (&scroll_bar_windows[i], 0, nbytes - old_nbytes);
4211 scroll_bar_windows_size = new_size;
4214 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4215 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4216 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4217 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4218 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4219 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4221 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4222 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4223 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4224 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4225 #endif
4227 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4228 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4229 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4230 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4231 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4235 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4236 in *IEVENT. */
4238 static void
4239 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *event, struct input_event *ievent)
4241 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4242 Lisp_Object window;
4243 struct frame *f;
4244 struct window *w;
4246 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4247 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4249 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4250 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4252 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4253 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4254 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4255 #ifdef USE_GTK
4256 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4257 #else
4258 ievent->timestamp = XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
4259 #endif
4260 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4261 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4262 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4263 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4264 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4268 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4270 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4272 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4275 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4276 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4277 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4279 static void
4280 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4282 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4283 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4284 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4286 switch (cs->reason)
4288 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4289 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4290 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4291 break;
4293 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4294 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4295 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4296 break;
4298 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4299 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4300 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4301 break;
4303 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4304 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4305 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4306 break;
4308 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4309 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4310 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4311 break;
4313 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4314 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4315 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4316 break;
4318 case XmCR_DRAG:
4320 int slider_size;
4322 /* Get the slider size. */
4323 BLOCK_INPUT;
4324 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4325 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4327 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4328 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4329 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4330 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4332 break;
4334 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4335 break;
4338 if (part >= 0)
4340 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4341 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4342 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4346 #elif defined USE_GTK
4348 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4349 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4351 static gboolean
4352 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange *range,
4353 GtkScrollType scroll,
4354 gdouble value,
4355 gpointer user_data)
4357 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4358 gdouble position;
4359 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4360 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range));
4361 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range), XG_FRAME_DATA);
4363 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return FALSE;
4364 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4367 switch (scroll)
4369 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP:
4370 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4371 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed != 0
4372 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed < (1 << 4))
4374 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4375 whole = gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj) -
4376 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj);
4377 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4378 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4380 break;
4381 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD:
4382 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4383 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4384 break;
4385 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD:
4386 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4387 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4388 break;
4389 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD:
4390 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4391 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4392 break;
4393 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD:
4394 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4395 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4396 break;
4399 if (part >= 0)
4401 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4402 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4403 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4406 return FALSE;
4409 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to Qnil when dragging is done. */
4411 static gboolean
4412 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget *widget,
4413 GdkEventButton *event,
4414 gpointer user_data)
4416 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4417 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4418 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4420 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4421 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4422 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4425 return FALSE;
4429 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4431 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4432 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4433 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4434 the thumb is. */
4436 static void
4437 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4439 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4440 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4441 float shown;
4442 int whole, portion, height;
4443 int part;
4445 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4446 BLOCK_INPUT;
4447 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4448 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4450 whole = 10000000;
4451 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4453 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
4454 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4455 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4456 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4457 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4458 bottom). */
4459 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4460 else
4461 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4463 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4464 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4465 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4466 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4470 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4471 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4472 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4473 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4474 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4475 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4476 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4478 static void
4479 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4481 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4482 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4483 int position = (long) call_data;
4484 Dimension height;
4485 int part;
4487 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4488 BLOCK_INPUT;
4489 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4490 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4492 if (eabs (position) >= height)
4493 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4495 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4496 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4497 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4498 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4499 else
4500 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4502 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4503 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4504 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4505 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4508 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4510 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4512 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4513 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4515 #ifdef USE_GTK
4516 static void
4517 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4519 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4521 BLOCK_INPUT;
4522 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4523 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback),
4524 scroll_bar_name);
4525 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4528 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4530 static void
4531 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4533 Window xwindow;
4534 Widget widget;
4535 Arg av[20];
4536 int ac = 0;
4537 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4538 unsigned long pixel;
4540 BLOCK_INPUT;
4542 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4543 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4544 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4545 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4546 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4547 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4548 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4549 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4550 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4552 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4553 if (pixel != -1)
4555 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4556 ++ac;
4559 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4560 if (pixel != -1)
4562 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4563 ++ac;
4566 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4567 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4569 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4570 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4571 (XtPointer) bar);
4572 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4573 (XtPointer) bar);
4574 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4575 (XtPointer) bar);
4576 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4577 (XtPointer) bar);
4578 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4579 (XtPointer) bar);
4580 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4581 (XtPointer) bar);
4582 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4583 (XtPointer) bar);
4585 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4586 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4588 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4589 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4590 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4591 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4593 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4595 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4596 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4597 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4598 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4599 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4600 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4601 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4602 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4604 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4605 if (pixel != -1)
4607 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4608 ++ac;
4611 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4612 if (pixel != -1)
4614 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4615 ++ac;
4618 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4620 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4621 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4623 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4624 if (pixel != -1)
4626 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4627 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4628 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4629 pixel = -1;
4630 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4633 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4635 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4636 if (pixel != -1)
4638 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4639 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4640 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4641 pixel = -1;
4642 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4646 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4647 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4648 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4649 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4650 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4651 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4652 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4653 colors itself. */
4655 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap,
4656 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f)) < 16);
4657 ++ac;
4659 else
4660 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4661 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4662 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4664 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4665 the shadows. */
4666 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4667 ++ac;
4669 /* Specify the colors. */
4670 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4671 if (pixel != -1)
4673 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4674 ++ac;
4676 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4677 if (pixel != -1)
4679 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4680 ++ac;
4683 #endif
4685 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4686 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4689 char *initial = "";
4690 char *val = initial;
4691 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4692 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4693 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4694 #endif
4695 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4696 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4697 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4698 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4699 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4700 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4704 /* Define callbacks. */
4705 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4706 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4707 (XtPointer) bar);
4709 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4710 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4712 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4714 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4715 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4716 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4717 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4719 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4720 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4721 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4722 bar->x_window = xwindow;
4724 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4726 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4729 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4730 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4732 #ifdef USE_GTK
4733 static void
4734 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position, int whole)
4736 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4739 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4740 static void
4741 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position,
4742 int whole)
4744 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4745 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4746 float top, shown;
4748 BLOCK_INPUT;
4750 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4752 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4753 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4754 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4755 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4756 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4757 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4758 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4759 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4760 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4761 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4762 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4763 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4764 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4765 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4766 whole += portion;
4768 if (whole <= 0)
4769 top = 0, shown = 1;
4770 else
4772 top = (float) position / whole;
4773 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4776 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4778 int size, value;
4780 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4781 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4782 value. */
4783 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4784 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4785 size = max (size, 1);
4787 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4788 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4789 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4791 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4793 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4795 if (whole == 0)
4796 top = 0, shown = 1;
4797 else
4799 top = (float) position / whole;
4800 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4804 float old_top, old_shown;
4805 Dimension height;
4806 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4807 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4808 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4809 XtNheight, &height,
4810 NULL);
4812 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4813 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4814 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4815 else
4816 top = old_top;
4817 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4818 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
4820 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4821 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4822 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4823 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4825 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4826 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4827 else
4829 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4830 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4831 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4833 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4837 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4839 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4841 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4843 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4847 /************************************************************************
4848 Scroll bars, general
4849 ************************************************************************/
4851 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4852 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4853 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4854 scroll bar. */
4856 static struct scroll_bar *
4857 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window *w, int top, int left, int width, int height)
4859 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4860 struct scroll_bar *bar
4861 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
4863 BLOCK_INPUT;
4865 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4866 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4867 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4869 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4870 unsigned long mask;
4871 Window window;
4873 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4874 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4875 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
4877 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4878 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4879 | ExposureMask);
4880 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4882 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4884 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4885 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4886 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4887 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4888 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4889 left, top, width,
4890 window_box_height (w), False);
4892 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4893 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4894 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4895 top,
4896 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4897 height,
4898 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4900 CopyFromParent,
4901 CopyFromParent,
4902 CopyFromParent,
4903 /* Attributes. */
4904 mask, &a);
4905 bar->x_window = window;
4907 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4909 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4910 bar->top = top;
4911 bar->left = left;
4912 bar->width = width;
4913 bar->height = height;
4914 bar->start = 0;
4915 bar->end = 0;
4916 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4917 bar->fringe_extended_p = 0;
4919 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4920 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4921 bar->prev = Qnil;
4922 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
4923 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4924 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4926 /* Map the window/widget. */
4927 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4929 #ifdef USE_GTK
4930 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4931 bar->x_window,
4932 top,
4933 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4934 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4935 max (height, 1));
4936 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4937 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4938 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
4939 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4940 top,
4941 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4942 max (height, 1), 0);
4943 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
4944 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4946 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4947 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
4948 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4950 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4951 return bar;
4955 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4957 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
4959 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
4960 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
4961 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
4962 events.)
4964 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
4965 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
4966 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
4967 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
4968 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
4970 static void
4971 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar *bar, int start, int end, int rebuild)
4973 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
4974 Window w = bar->x_window;
4975 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4976 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
4978 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
4979 if (! rebuild
4980 && start == bar->start
4981 && end == bar->end)
4982 return;
4984 BLOCK_INPUT;
4987 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
4988 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
4989 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
4991 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
4992 the distance between start and end. */
4994 int length = end - start;
4996 if (start < 0)
4997 start = 0;
4998 else if (start > top_range)
4999 start = top_range;
5000 end = start + length;
5002 if (end < start)
5003 end = start;
5004 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
5005 end = top_range;
5008 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5009 bar->start = start;
5010 bar->end = end;
5012 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5013 if (end > top_range)
5014 end = top_range;
5016 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5017 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5018 that many pixels tall. */
5019 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
5021 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5022 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5023 if (0 < start)
5024 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5025 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5026 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5027 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
5028 inside_width, start,
5029 False);
5031 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5032 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5033 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5034 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5036 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5037 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5038 /* x, y, width, height */
5039 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5040 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
5041 inside_width, end - start);
5043 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5044 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5045 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5046 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5048 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5049 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5050 if (end < inside_height)
5051 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5052 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5053 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5054 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
5055 inside_width, inside_height - end,
5056 False);
5060 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5063 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5065 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5066 nil. */
5068 static void
5069 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar *bar)
5071 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5072 BLOCK_INPUT;
5074 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5075 #ifdef USE_GTK
5076 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
5077 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5078 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5079 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5080 #else
5081 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5082 #endif
5084 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5085 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5087 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5091 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5092 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5093 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5094 create one. */
5096 static void
5097 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w, int portion, int whole, int position)
5099 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5100 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5101 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5102 int window_y, window_height;
5103 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5104 int fringe_extended_p;
5105 #endif
5107 /* Get window dimensions. */
5108 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5109 top = window_y;
5110 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5111 height = window_height;
5113 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5114 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5116 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5117 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5118 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5119 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5120 else
5121 sb_width = width;
5123 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5124 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5125 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5126 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w) ? width - sb_width : 0);
5127 else
5128 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w) ? 0 : width - sb_width);
5129 #else
5130 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5131 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5132 else
5133 sb_left = left;
5134 #endif
5136 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5137 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5138 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5139 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5140 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5141 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5142 else
5143 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5144 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5145 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5146 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5147 #endif
5149 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5150 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5152 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5154 BLOCK_INPUT;
5155 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5156 if (fringe_extended_p)
5157 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5158 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5159 else
5160 #endif
5161 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5162 left, top, width, height, False);
5163 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5166 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5168 else
5170 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5171 unsigned int mask = 0;
5173 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5175 BLOCK_INPUT;
5177 if (sb_left != bar->left)
5178 mask |= CWX;
5179 if (top != bar->top)
5180 mask |= CWY;
5181 if (sb_width != bar->width)
5182 mask |= CWWidth;
5183 if (height != bar->height)
5184 mask |= CWHeight;
5186 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5188 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5189 if (mask || bar->fringe_extended_p != fringe_extended_p)
5191 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5192 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5193 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5195 if (fringe_extended_p)
5196 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5197 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5198 else
5199 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5200 left, top, width, height, False);
5202 #ifdef USE_GTK
5203 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5204 bar->x_window,
5205 top,
5206 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5207 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5208 max (height, 1));
5209 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5210 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5211 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5212 top,
5213 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5214 max (height, 1), 0);
5215 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5217 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5219 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5220 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5221 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5223 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5224 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5225 height, False);
5226 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5227 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5228 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5229 height, False);
5232 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5233 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5234 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5235 example. */
5237 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5238 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5239 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5241 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5242 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5243 left + area_width - rest, top,
5244 rest, height, False);
5245 else
5246 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5247 left, top, rest, height, False);
5251 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5252 if (mask)
5254 XWindowChanges wc;
5256 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5257 wc.y = top;
5258 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5259 wc.height = height;
5260 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5261 mask, &wc);
5264 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5266 /* Remember new settings. */
5267 bar->left = sb_left;
5268 bar->top = top;
5269 bar->width = sb_width;
5270 bar->height = height;
5272 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5275 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5276 bar->fringe_extended_p = fringe_extended_p;
5278 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5279 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5280 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5281 dragged. */
5282 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5284 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5286 if (whole == 0)
5287 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5288 else
5290 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5291 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5292 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5295 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5297 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5301 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5302 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5303 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5304 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5305 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5306 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5307 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5309 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5310 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5311 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5313 static void
5314 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR frame)
5316 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5317 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5319 Lisp_Object bar;
5320 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5321 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5322 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5323 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5324 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5325 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5326 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5331 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5332 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5334 static void
5335 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window *window)
5337 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5338 struct frame *f;
5340 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5341 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5342 abort ();
5344 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5346 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5347 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5348 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5350 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5351 the lists. */
5352 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5353 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5354 return;
5355 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5356 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5357 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5358 else
5359 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5360 one or the other! */
5361 abort ();
5363 else
5364 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5366 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5367 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5369 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5370 bar->prev = Qnil;
5371 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5372 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5373 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5376 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5377 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5379 static void
5380 XTjudge_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR f)
5382 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5384 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5386 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5387 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5388 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5390 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5392 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5394 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5396 next = b->next;
5397 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5400 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5401 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5405 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5406 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5407 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5409 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5410 mark bits. */
5412 static void
5413 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5415 Window w = bar->x_window;
5416 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5417 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5418 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5420 BLOCK_INPUT;
5422 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, 1);
5424 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5425 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5426 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5427 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5429 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5430 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5432 /* x, y, width, height */
5433 0, 0,
5434 bar->width - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5435 bar->height - 1);
5437 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5438 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5439 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5440 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5442 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5445 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5447 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5448 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5450 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5451 mark bits. */
5454 static void
5455 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event, struct input_event *emacs_event)
5457 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
5458 abort ();
5460 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5461 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5462 emacs_event->modifiers
5463 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5464 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5465 event->xbutton.state)
5466 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5467 ? up_modifier
5468 : down_modifier));
5469 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5470 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5471 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5473 int top_range
5474 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5475 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5477 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5478 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5480 if (y < bar->start)
5481 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5482 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5483 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5484 else
5485 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5487 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5488 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5489 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5490 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5492 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5493 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5495 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5496 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5498 #endif
5500 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5501 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5505 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5507 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5509 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5510 mark bits. */
5512 static void
5513 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5515 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5517 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5519 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5520 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5522 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5523 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5525 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5526 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5528 if (new_start != bar->start)
5530 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5532 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5537 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5539 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5540 on the scroll bar. */
5542 static void
5543 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (FRAME_PTR *fp, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
5544 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x,
5545 Lisp_Object *y, long unsigned int *timestamp)
5547 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5548 Window w = bar->x_window;
5549 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5550 int win_x, win_y;
5551 Window dummy_window;
5552 int dummy_coord;
5553 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5555 BLOCK_INPUT;
5557 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5558 report that. */
5559 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5561 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5562 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5563 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5565 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5566 &win_x, &win_y,
5568 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5569 &dummy_mask))
5571 else
5573 int top_range
5574 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5576 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5578 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5579 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5581 if (win_y < 0)
5582 win_y = 0;
5583 if (win_y > top_range)
5584 win_y = top_range;
5586 *fp = f;
5587 *bar_window = bar->window;
5589 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5590 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5591 else if (win_y < bar->start)
5592 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5593 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5594 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5595 else
5596 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5598 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5599 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5601 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5602 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5605 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
5607 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5611 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5612 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5613 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5614 redraw them. */
5616 static void
5617 x_scroll_bar_clear (FRAME_PTR f)
5619 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5620 Lisp_Object bar;
5622 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5623 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5624 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5625 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5626 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5627 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5628 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5629 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
5630 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5631 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5635 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5637 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5638 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5639 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5640 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5642 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5643 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5645 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5647 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5648 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5650 static int temp_index;
5651 static short temp_buffer[100];
5653 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5654 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5655 temp_index = 0; \
5656 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5658 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5659 on a particular display. */
5661 struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5663 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5664 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5665 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5666 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5668 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5670 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT \
5671 do \
5673 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5674 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5675 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5676 *f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = event; \
5677 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5678 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5680 while (0)
5682 enum
5684 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5685 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5686 X_EVENT_DROP
5689 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5690 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5691 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5693 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5694 this event further.
5695 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5697 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5698 static int
5699 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event)
5701 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5702 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5703 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5704 was created. */
5706 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5707 event->xclient.window);
5709 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5711 #endif
5713 #ifdef USE_GTK
5714 static int current_count;
5715 static int current_finish;
5716 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5718 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5719 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5720 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5721 static GdkFilterReturn
5722 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent *gxev, GdkEvent *ev, gpointer data)
5724 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5726 BLOCK_INPUT;
5727 if (current_count >= 0)
5729 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5731 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5733 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5734 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5735 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5736 so we do it here. */
5737 if ((xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5738 && dpyinfo
5739 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5741 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5742 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5744 #endif
5746 if (! dpyinfo)
5747 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5748 else
5749 current_count +=
5750 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5751 current_hold_quit);
5753 else
5754 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5756 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5758 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5759 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5761 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5763 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5766 static void xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time time,
5767 enum xembed_message message,
5768 long detail, long data1, long data2);
5770 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5772 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5773 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5774 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5776 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5778 static int
5779 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *eventptr,
5780 int *finish, struct input_event *hold_quit)
5782 union {
5783 struct input_event ie;
5784 struct selection_input_event sie;
5785 } inev;
5786 int count = 0;
5787 int do_help = 0;
5788 int nbytes = 0;
5789 struct frame *f = NULL;
5790 struct coding_system coding;
5791 XEvent event = *eventptr;
5792 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
5794 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5796 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5797 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5798 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5800 if (pending_event_wait.eventtype == event.type)
5801 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
5803 switch (event.type)
5805 case ClientMessage:
5807 if (event.xclient.message_type
5808 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5809 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5811 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5812 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5814 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5815 could be the shell widget window
5816 if the frame has no title bar. */
5817 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5818 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5819 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5820 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5821 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5822 #endif
5823 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5824 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5825 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5826 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5827 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5828 needed.
5830 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5831 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5832 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5833 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5834 Emacs. */
5836 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5837 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5838 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5839 if (f)
5841 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5842 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5843 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5844 x_catch_errors (d);
5845 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5846 /* The ICCCM says this is
5847 the only valid choice. */
5848 RevertToParent,
5849 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5850 /* This is needed to detect the error
5851 if there is an error. */
5852 XSync (d, False);
5853 x_uncatch_errors ();
5855 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5856 #endif /* 0 */
5857 goto done;
5860 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5861 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5863 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5864 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5865 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5866 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5867 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5868 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5869 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5870 session manager and one for this. */
5871 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5872 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5873 #endif
5875 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5876 event.xclient.window);
5877 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5878 for a single Emacs process. */
5879 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5880 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5881 event.xclient.window,
5882 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5883 else if (f)
5884 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5885 event.xclient.window,
5886 0, 0);
5888 goto done;
5891 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5892 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5894 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5895 event.xclient.window);
5896 if (!f)
5897 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5899 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5900 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5901 goto done;
5904 goto done;
5907 if (event.xclient.message_type
5908 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5910 goto done;
5913 if (event.xclient.message_type
5914 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5916 int new_x, new_y;
5917 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5919 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5920 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5922 if (f)
5924 f->left_pos = new_x;
5925 f->top_pos = new_y;
5927 goto done;
5930 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
5931 if (event.xclient.message_type
5932 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
5934 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5935 if (f)
5936 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
5937 &event, NULL);
5938 goto done;
5940 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
5942 if ((event.xclient.message_type
5943 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
5944 || (event.xclient.message_type
5945 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
5947 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
5948 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
5949 currently never do because we are interested in
5950 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
5951 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
5952 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5953 if (!f)
5954 goto OTHER;
5955 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
5956 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
5957 goto done;
5960 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5961 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
5962 we construct an input_event. */
5963 if (event.xclient.message_type
5964 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
5966 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
5967 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
5968 goto done;
5970 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5972 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
5973 if (event.xclient.message_type
5974 == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
5976 enum xembed_message msg = event.xclient.data.l[1];
5977 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
5978 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
5980 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
5981 goto done;
5984 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
5986 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5987 if (!f)
5988 goto OTHER;
5989 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
5990 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
5992 break;
5994 case SelectionNotify:
5995 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
5996 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5997 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
5998 goto OTHER;
5999 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6000 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
6001 break;
6003 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6004 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
6005 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6006 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
6007 goto OTHER;
6008 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6010 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = (XSelectionClearEvent *) &event;
6012 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
6013 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6014 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6015 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6016 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6018 break;
6020 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6021 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
6022 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6023 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
6024 goto OTHER;
6025 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6027 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp
6028 = (XSelectionRequestEvent *) &event;
6030 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
6031 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6032 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
6033 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6034 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
6035 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
6036 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6037 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6039 break;
6041 case PropertyNotify:
6042 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
6043 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window);
6044 if (f && event.xproperty.atom == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state)
6045 x_handle_net_wm_state (f, &event.xproperty);
6047 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
6048 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6049 goto OTHER;
6051 case ReparentNotify:
6052 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
6053 if (f)
6055 int x, y;
6056 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
6057 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
6058 f->left_pos = x;
6059 f->top_pos = y;
6061 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6062 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
6063 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
6065 goto OTHER;
6067 case Expose:
6068 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
6069 if (f)
6071 #ifdef USE_GTK
6072 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
6073 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
6074 event.xexpose.window,
6075 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6076 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
6077 FALSE);
6078 #endif
6079 if (f->async_visible == 0)
6081 f->async_visible = 1;
6082 f->async_iconified = 0;
6083 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6084 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6086 else
6087 expose_frame (f,
6088 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6089 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6091 else
6093 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6094 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6095 #endif
6096 #if defined USE_LUCID
6097 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6098 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6099 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6101 Widget widget
6102 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6103 if (widget)
6104 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6106 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6108 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6109 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6110 goto OTHER;
6111 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6112 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6113 event.xexpose.window);
6115 if (bar)
6116 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6117 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6118 else
6119 goto OTHER;
6120 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6121 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6123 break;
6125 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6126 source area was obscured or not
6127 available. */
6128 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6129 if (f)
6131 expose_frame (f,
6132 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6133 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6134 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6136 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6137 else
6138 goto OTHER;
6139 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6140 break;
6142 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6143 source area was completely
6144 available. */
6145 break;
6147 case UnmapNotify:
6148 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6149 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6151 tip_window = 0;
6152 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6155 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6156 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6157 the frame was deleted. */
6159 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6160 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6161 display that won't ever be seen. */
6162 f->async_visible = 0;
6163 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6164 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6165 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6166 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6167 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6168 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6169 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6171 f->async_iconified = 1;
6173 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6174 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6177 goto OTHER;
6179 case MapNotify:
6180 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6181 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6182 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6183 goto OTHER;
6185 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6186 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6187 frame is visible. */
6188 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6189 if (f)
6191 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6192 the frame's display structures.
6193 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6194 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6195 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6196 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6197 if (! f->async_iconified)
6198 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6200 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
6201 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
6202 if (!f->output_data.x->has_been_visible)
6203 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6205 f->async_visible = 1;
6206 f->async_iconified = 0;
6207 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6209 if (f->iconified)
6211 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6212 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6214 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6215 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6216 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6217 to update the frame titles
6218 in case this is the second frame. */
6219 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6221 #ifdef USE_GTK
6222 xg_frame_resized (f, -1, -1);
6223 #endif
6225 goto OTHER;
6227 case KeyPress:
6229 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6230 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6232 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6233 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6234 if (popup_activated ())
6235 goto OTHER;
6236 #endif
6238 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6240 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6241 mouse highlighting. */
6242 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6243 && (f == 0
6244 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6246 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6247 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6250 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6251 if (f == 0)
6253 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6254 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6255 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6256 event.xkey.window);
6257 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6259 widget = XtParent (widget);
6260 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6263 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6265 if (f != 0)
6267 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6268 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6269 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6270 his Emacs hang.
6272 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6273 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6274 status_return even if the input is too long to
6275 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6276 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6277 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6278 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6279 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6280 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6281 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6282 int modifiers;
6283 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6284 Lisp_Object c;
6286 #ifdef USE_GTK
6287 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6288 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6289 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6290 (see above). */
6291 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6292 #endif
6294 event.xkey.state
6295 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6296 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6297 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6299 /* This will have to go some day... */
6301 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6302 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6303 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6304 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6305 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6306 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6307 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6309 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6310 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6311 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6312 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6313 not it is combined with Meta. */
6314 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6315 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6317 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6318 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6320 Status status_return;
6322 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6323 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6324 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6325 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6326 &status_return);
6327 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6329 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6330 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6331 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6332 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6333 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6334 &status_return);
6336 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6337 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6338 break;
6339 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6341 keysym = NoSymbol;
6342 modifiers = 0;
6344 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6345 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6346 abort ();
6348 else
6349 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6350 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6351 &compose_status);
6352 #else
6353 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6354 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6355 &compose_status);
6356 #endif
6358 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6359 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6360 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6361 break;
6363 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6364 orig_keysym = keysym;
6366 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6367 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6368 inev.ie.modifiers
6369 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6370 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6372 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6373 translations to characters. */
6374 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6375 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6377 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6378 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6379 goto done_keysym;
6382 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6383 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
6385 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
6386 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6387 else
6388 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6389 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
6390 goto done_keysym;
6393 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6394 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6395 && (NATNUMP (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6396 Vx_keysym_table,
6397 Qnil))))
6399 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6400 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6401 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6402 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6403 goto done_keysym;
6406 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6407 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6408 || keysym == XK_Delete
6409 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6410 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6411 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6412 #endif
6413 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6414 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6415 #ifdef HPUX
6416 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6417 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6418 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6419 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6420 || ((unsigned) (keysym) >= XK_Select
6421 && (unsigned)(keysym) < XK_KP_Space)
6422 #endif
6423 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6424 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6425 #endif
6426 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6427 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6428 #endif
6429 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6430 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6431 #endif
6432 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6433 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6434 #endif
6435 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6436 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6437 #endif
6438 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6439 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6440 #endif
6441 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6442 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6443 #endif
6444 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6445 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6446 #endif
6447 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6448 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6449 #endif
6450 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6451 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6452 #endif
6453 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6454 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6455 #endif
6456 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6457 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6458 #endif
6459 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6460 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6461 #endif
6462 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6463 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6464 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6465 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6466 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6467 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6468 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6469 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6470 don't have real modifiers but
6471 should be treated similarly to
6472 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6473 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6474 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6475 >= XK_ISO_Lock
6476 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6477 <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6478 #endif
6481 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6482 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6483 key. */
6484 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6485 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6486 goto done_keysym;
6489 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6490 register int i;
6491 int nchars, len;
6493 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6495 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
6496 nchars++;
6497 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6500 if (nchars < nbytes)
6502 /* Decode the input data. */
6503 int require;
6505 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6506 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6507 we used just above and the locale. */
6508 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6509 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6510 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6511 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6512 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6513 gives us composition information. */
6514 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
6516 require = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
6517 coding.destination = alloca (require);
6518 coding.dst_bytes = require;
6519 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6520 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
6521 nbytes = coding.produced;
6522 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6523 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
6526 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6527 character events. */
6528 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6530 int ch;
6531 if (nchars == nbytes)
6532 ch = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6533 else
6534 ch = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i, len);
6535 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (ch)
6536 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6537 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6538 inev.ie.code = ch;
6539 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6542 count += nchars;
6544 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6546 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6547 break;
6550 done_keysym:
6551 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6552 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6553 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6554 client. */
6555 break;
6556 #else
6557 goto OTHER;
6558 #endif
6560 case KeyRelease:
6561 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6562 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6563 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6564 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6565 client. */
6566 break;
6567 #else
6568 goto OTHER;
6569 #endif
6571 case EnterNotify:
6572 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6573 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6575 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6577 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6578 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6580 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6581 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6582 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6583 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6584 #ifdef USE_GTK
6585 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6586 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6587 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6588 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6589 #endif
6590 goto OTHER;
6592 case FocusIn:
6593 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6594 goto OTHER;
6596 case LeaveNotify:
6597 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6598 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6600 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6601 if (f)
6603 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6605 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6606 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6607 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6608 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6611 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6612 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6613 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6614 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6615 if (any_help_event_p)
6616 do_help = -1;
6618 #ifdef USE_GTK
6619 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6620 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6621 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6622 #endif
6623 goto OTHER;
6625 case FocusOut:
6626 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6627 goto OTHER;
6629 case MotionNotify:
6631 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6632 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6633 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6635 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6636 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6637 f = last_mouse_frame;
6638 else
6639 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6641 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6643 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6644 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6647 #ifdef USE_GTK
6648 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6649 f = 0;
6650 #endif
6651 if (f)
6654 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
6655 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
6656 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window) && !popup_activated ())
6658 Lisp_Object window;
6660 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6661 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6662 0, 0);
6664 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6665 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6666 will be selected only when it is active. */
6667 if (WINDOWP (window)
6668 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6669 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6670 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6671 create event iff we don't leave the
6672 selected frame. */
6673 && (focus_follows_mouse
6674 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
6675 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
6677 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6678 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6681 last_window=window;
6683 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6684 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6686 else
6688 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6689 struct scroll_bar *bar
6690 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6691 event.xmotion.window);
6693 if (bar)
6694 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6695 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6697 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6698 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6699 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6702 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6703 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6704 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6705 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6706 do_help = 1;
6707 goto OTHER;
6710 case ConfigureNotify:
6711 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6712 #ifdef USE_GTK
6713 if (!f
6714 && (f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window))
6715 && event.xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
6717 xg_frame_resized (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6718 event.xconfigure.height);
6719 f = 0;
6721 #endif
6722 if (f)
6724 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6725 #ifndef USE_GTK
6726 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6727 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6729 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6730 is called by the code that handles resizing
6731 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6733 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6734 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6735 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6736 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6737 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6738 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6739 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6741 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6742 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6743 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6746 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6747 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6748 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6749 #endif
6751 #ifdef USE_GTK
6752 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6753 Only get real positions when mapped. */
6754 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6755 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6756 #endif
6758 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6761 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6762 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6763 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6764 #endif
6767 goto OTHER;
6769 case ButtonRelease:
6770 case ButtonPress:
6772 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6773 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6774 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6776 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6777 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6778 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
6780 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6781 && last_mouse_frame
6782 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6783 f = last_mouse_frame;
6784 else
6785 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6787 #ifdef USE_GTK
6788 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6789 f = 0;
6790 #endif
6791 if (f)
6793 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6794 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6795 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6797 Lisp_Object window;
6798 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6799 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6801 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 1);
6802 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
6804 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
6806 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y,
6807 event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
6808 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6809 event.xbutton.state));
6813 if (!tool_bar_p)
6814 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6815 if (! popup_activated ())
6816 #endif
6818 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6820 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6821 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6823 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6824 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6826 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6827 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6829 else
6830 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6832 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
6833 xembed_send_message (f, event.xbutton.time,
6834 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
6836 else
6838 struct scroll_bar *bar
6839 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6840 event.xbutton.window);
6842 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6843 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6844 scroll bars. */
6845 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6847 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6848 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6850 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6851 if (bar)
6852 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6853 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6856 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6858 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6859 last_mouse_frame = f;
6861 if (!tool_bar_p)
6862 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6864 else
6865 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6867 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6868 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6869 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6870 if (f != 0)
6871 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6873 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6874 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, &event);
6875 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6876 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6877 Instead, save it away
6878 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6879 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6880 if (! popup_activated ()
6881 #ifdef USE_GTK
6882 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
6883 && event.xbutton.button < 3
6884 #endif
6885 && f && event.type == ButtonPress
6886 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6887 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6888 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6889 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6890 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6891 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6892 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6894 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6895 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6896 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6898 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6900 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6901 goto OTHER;
6903 else
6904 goto OTHER;
6905 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6907 break;
6909 case CirculateNotify:
6910 goto OTHER;
6912 case CirculateRequest:
6913 goto OTHER;
6915 case VisibilityNotify:
6916 goto OTHER;
6918 case MappingNotify:
6919 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6920 local cache. */
6921 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6923 case MappingModifier:
6924 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6925 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6926 case MappingKeyboard:
6927 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
6929 goto OTHER;
6931 case DestroyNotify:
6932 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6933 break;
6935 default:
6936 OTHER:
6937 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6938 BLOCK_INPUT;
6939 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
6940 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
6941 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6942 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6943 break;
6946 done:
6947 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
6949 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6950 count++;
6953 if (do_help
6954 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
6956 Lisp_Object frame;
6958 if (f)
6959 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
6960 else
6961 frame = Qnil;
6963 if (do_help > 0)
6965 any_help_event_p = 1;
6966 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
6967 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
6969 else
6971 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6972 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
6974 count++;
6977 *eventptr = event;
6978 return count;
6982 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
6983 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
6984 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
6986 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
6988 x_dispatch_event (XEvent *event, Display *display)
6990 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6991 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
6993 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
6995 if (dpyinfo)
6996 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
6998 return finish;
7002 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7003 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
7004 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7006 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7007 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7008 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7009 C chars).
7011 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
7013 static int
7014 XTread_socket (struct terminal *terminal, int expected, struct input_event *hold_quit)
7016 int count = 0;
7017 int event_found = 0;
7019 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
7021 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
7022 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7023 pending_signals = 1;
7024 #endif
7025 return -1;
7028 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
7029 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7030 pending_signals = pending_atimers;
7031 #endif
7032 BLOCK_INPUT;
7034 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7035 input_signal_count++;
7037 ++handling_signal;
7039 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7040 if (terminal->display_info.x == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7042 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7043 x_io_error_quitter (terminal->display_info.x->display);
7046 #ifndef USE_GTK
7047 while (XPending (terminal->display_info.x->display))
7049 int finish;
7050 XEvent event;
7052 XNextEvent (terminal->display_info.x->display, &event);
7054 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7055 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7056 if (x_filter_event (terminal->display_info.x, &event))
7057 continue;
7058 #endif
7059 event_found = 1;
7061 count += handle_one_xevent (terminal->display_info.x,
7062 &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7064 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7065 goto out;
7068 out:;
7070 #else /* USE_GTK */
7072 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7073 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7074 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7075 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7077 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7078 from all displays. */
7080 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7082 current_count = count;
7083 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7085 gtk_main_iteration ();
7087 count = current_count;
7088 current_count = -1;
7089 current_hold_quit = 0;
7091 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7092 break;
7094 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7096 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7097 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7098 if (! event_found)
7100 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7101 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7102 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7103 x_noop_count++;
7104 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7106 x_noop_count=0;
7108 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7109 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7111 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7113 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7114 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7118 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7119 raise it now. */
7120 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7121 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7123 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7124 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7127 --handling_signal;
7128 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7130 return count;
7136 /***********************************************************************
7137 Text Cursor
7138 ***********************************************************************/
7140 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7141 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7143 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7144 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7145 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7147 static void
7148 x_clip_to_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int area, GC gc)
7150 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7151 XRectangle clip_rect;
7152 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7154 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7156 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7157 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7158 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7159 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7160 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7162 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7166 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7168 static void
7169 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
7171 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7172 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7173 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7174 int x, y, wd, h;
7175 XGCValues xgcv;
7176 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7177 GC gc;
7179 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7180 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7181 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7182 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7183 return;
7185 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7186 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7187 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7189 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7190 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7191 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7192 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7193 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7194 else
7195 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7196 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7197 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7199 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7200 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7201 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7202 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7206 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7208 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7209 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7210 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7211 --gerd. */
7213 static void
7214 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int width, enum text_cursor_kinds kind)
7216 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7217 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7219 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7220 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7221 and mini-buffer. */
7222 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7223 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7224 return;
7226 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7227 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7228 the bar might not be in the window. */
7229 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7231 struct glyph_row *r;
7232 r = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7233 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, r, DRAW_CURSOR);
7235 else
7237 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7238 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7239 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7240 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7241 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7242 XGCValues xgcv;
7244 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7245 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7246 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7247 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7248 that the glyph is legible. */
7249 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7250 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7251 else
7252 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7253 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7255 if (gc)
7256 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7257 else
7259 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7260 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7263 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7265 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7267 int x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7269 if (width < 0)
7270 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7271 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7273 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7275 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
7276 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
7277 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0)
7278 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - width;
7280 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc, x,
7281 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7282 width, row->height);
7284 else
7286 int dummy_x, dummy_y, dummy_h;
7288 if (width < 0)
7289 width = row->height;
7291 width = min (row->height, width);
7293 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &dummy_x,
7294 &dummy_y, &dummy_h);
7296 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7297 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7298 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7299 row->height - width),
7300 w->phys_cursor_width, width);
7303 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7308 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7310 static void
7311 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor)
7313 if (!f->pointer_invisible
7314 && f->output_data.x->current_cursor != cursor)
7315 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7316 f->output_data.x->current_cursor = cursor;
7320 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7322 static void
7323 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height)
7325 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7326 x, y, width, height, False);
7327 #ifdef USE_GTK
7328 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
7329 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
7330 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
7331 #endif
7335 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7337 static void
7338 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *glyph_row, int x, int y, int cursor_type, int cursor_width, int on_p, int active_p)
7340 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7342 if (on_p)
7344 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7345 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7347 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7348 && (glyph_row->reversed_p
7349 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
7350 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
7352 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7353 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, glyph_row->reversed_p);
7355 else
7357 switch (cursor_type)
7359 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7360 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7361 break;
7363 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7364 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7365 break;
7367 case BAR_CURSOR:
7368 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7369 break;
7371 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7372 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7373 break;
7375 case NO_CURSOR:
7376 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7377 break;
7379 default:
7380 abort ();
7384 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7385 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7386 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7387 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7388 #endif
7391 #ifndef XFlush
7392 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7393 #endif
7397 /* Icons. */
7399 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7402 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object file)
7404 int bitmap_id;
7406 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7407 return 1;
7409 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7410 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7411 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7412 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7414 if (STRINGP (file))
7416 #ifdef USE_GTK
7417 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7418 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7419 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7420 return 0;
7421 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7422 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7423 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7425 else
7427 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7428 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7430 int rc = -1;
7432 #ifdef USE_GTK
7434 if (xg_set_icon (f, xg_default_icon_file)
7435 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7436 return 0;
7438 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7440 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7441 if (rc != -1)
7442 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7444 #endif
7446 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7447 if (rc == -1)
7449 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, (char *) gnu_xbm_bits,
7450 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7451 if (rc == -1)
7452 return 1;
7454 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7455 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7459 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7460 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7461 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7462 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7463 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7465 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7468 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7469 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7471 return 0;
7475 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7476 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7479 x_text_icon (struct frame *f, const char *icon_name)
7481 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7482 return 1;
7485 XTextProperty text;
7486 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7487 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7488 text.format = 8;
7489 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7490 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7493 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7494 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7495 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7496 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7498 return 0;
7501 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7503 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7504 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7506 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7507 be called from a signal handler.
7510 struct x_error_message_stack {
7511 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7512 Display *dpy;
7513 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7515 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7517 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7518 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7519 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7521 static void
7522 x_error_catcher (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7524 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code,
7525 x_error_message->string,
7526 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7529 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7530 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7531 operating on.
7533 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7534 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7535 stored in *x_error_message.
7537 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7538 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7540 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7542 void x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format);
7544 void
7545 x_catch_errors (Display *dpy)
7547 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof (*data));
7549 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7550 XSync (dpy, False);
7552 data->dpy = dpy;
7553 data->string[0] = 0;
7554 data->prev = x_error_message;
7555 x_error_message = data;
7558 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7559 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7561 void
7562 x_uncatch_errors (void)
7564 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7566 BLOCK_INPUT;
7568 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7569 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7570 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7571 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7573 tmp = x_error_message;
7574 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7575 xfree (tmp);
7576 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7579 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7580 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7581 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7583 void
7584 x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format)
7586 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7587 XSync (dpy, False);
7589 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7591 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7592 memcpy (string, x_error_message->string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7593 x_uncatch_errors ();
7594 error (format, string);
7598 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7599 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7602 x_had_errors_p (Display *dpy)
7604 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7605 XSync (dpy, False);
7607 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7610 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7612 void
7613 x_clear_errors (Display *dpy)
7615 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7618 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7619 * idea. --lorentey */
7620 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7622 void
7623 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
7625 while (x_error_message)
7626 x_uncatch_errors ();
7628 #endif
7630 /* Nonzero if x_catch_errors has been done and not yet canceled. */
7633 x_catching_errors (void)
7635 return x_error_message != 0;
7638 #if 0
7639 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7640 x_trace_wire (void)
7642 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7644 #endif /* ! 0 */
7647 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7648 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7649 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7650 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7651 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7653 static SIGTYPE
7654 x_connection_signal (int signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7655 /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7657 #ifdef USG
7658 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7659 must reestablish each time */
7660 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7661 #endif /* USG */
7665 /************************************************************************
7666 Handling X errors
7667 ************************************************************************/
7669 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7671 static char *error_msg;
7673 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7674 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7676 static SIGTYPE
7677 x_connection_closed (Display *dpy, const char *error_message)
7679 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7680 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7681 int idx = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7683 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7684 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7685 handling_signal = 0;
7687 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
7688 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
7690 if (dpyinfo)
7692 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
7693 frame on it. */
7694 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
7695 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
7698 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7699 that are on the dead display. */
7700 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7702 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7703 minibuf_frame
7704 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7705 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7706 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7707 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7708 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7709 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7712 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7713 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7714 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7715 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7716 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7717 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7719 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
7720 trying to find a replacement. */
7721 KVAR (FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame)), Vdefault_minibuffer_frame) = Qt;
7722 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7725 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display in the
7726 first place, so don't try to close it. */
7727 if (dpyinfo)
7729 /* We can not call XtCloseDisplay here because it calls XSync.
7730 XSync inside the error handler apparently hangs Emacs. On
7731 current Xt versions, this isn't needed either. */
7732 #ifdef USE_GTK
7733 /* A long-standing GTK bug prevents proper disconnect handling
7734 (https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). Once,
7735 the resulting Glib error message loop filled a user's disk.
7736 To avoid this, kill Emacs unconditionally on disconnect. */
7737 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7738 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n\
7739 When compiled with GTK, Emacs cannot recover from X disconnects.\n\
7740 This is a GTK bug: https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715\n\
7741 For details, see etc/PROBLEMS.\n",
7742 error_msg);
7743 abort ();
7744 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7746 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7747 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7749 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
7750 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
7751 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
7752 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
7753 abort ();
7756 Lisp_Object tmp;
7757 XSETTERMINAL (tmp, dpyinfo->terminal);
7758 Fdelete_terminal (tmp, Qnoelisp);
7762 if (terminal_list == 0)
7764 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7765 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
7766 /* NOTREACHED */
7769 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7770 #ifdef SIGIO
7771 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7772 #endif
7773 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7774 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7776 unbind_to (idx, Qnil);
7777 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7779 /* Tell GCC not to suggest attribute 'noreturn' for this function. */
7780 IF_LINT (if (! terminal_list) return; )
7782 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
7783 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
7784 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
7785 error ("%s", error_msg);
7788 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7789 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7790 static void x_error_quitter (Display *, XErrorEvent *);
7792 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7793 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7795 static int
7796 x_error_handler (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7798 if (x_error_message)
7799 x_error_catcher (display, event);
7800 else
7801 x_error_quitter (display, event);
7802 return 0;
7805 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7806 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7807 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7809 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7811 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7812 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7814 static void NO_INLINE
7815 x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7817 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7819 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7820 or colors that are not defined. */
7822 if (event->error_code == BadName)
7823 return;
7825 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7826 original error handler. */
7828 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7829 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7830 buf, event->request_code);
7831 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7835 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7836 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7837 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7839 static int
7840 x_io_error_quitter (Display *display)
7842 char buf[256];
7844 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
7845 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7846 return 0;
7849 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7851 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
7852 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
7853 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
7854 FONT-OBJECT. */
7856 Lisp_Object
7857 x_new_font (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object font_object, int fontset)
7859 struct font *font = XFONT_OBJECT (font_object);
7861 if (fontset < 0)
7862 fontset = fontset_from_font (font_object);
7863 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7864 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == font)
7865 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
7866 do. */
7867 return font_object;
7869 FRAME_FONT (f) = font;
7870 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->baseline_offset;
7871 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->average_width;
7872 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = font->space_width;
7873 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
7875 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7877 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7878 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7880 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7881 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7882 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7884 else
7886 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7887 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7890 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7892 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7893 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7894 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7895 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7896 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7899 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7900 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7901 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7903 BLOCK_INPUT;
7904 xic_set_xfontset (f, SSDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7905 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7907 #endif
7909 return font_object;
7913 /***********************************************************************
7914 X Input Methods
7915 ***********************************************************************/
7917 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7919 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7921 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7922 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7923 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7925 static void
7926 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
7928 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
7929 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7931 BLOCK_INPUT;
7933 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7934 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7936 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
7937 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
7939 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
7940 xic_free_xfontset (f);
7944 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
7945 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7946 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
7947 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7950 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
7952 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7953 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
7954 extern char *XSetIMValues (XIM, ...);
7955 #endif
7957 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
7958 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
7960 static void
7961 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
7963 XIM xim;
7965 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
7966 if (use_xim)
7968 if (dpyinfo->xim)
7969 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
7970 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
7971 emacs_class);
7972 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
7974 if (xim)
7976 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7977 XIMCallback destroy;
7978 #endif
7980 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
7981 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
7983 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7984 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
7985 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
7986 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
7987 #endif
7991 else
7992 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
7993 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7997 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
7999 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8000 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8001 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8002 when the callback was registered. */
8004 static void
8005 xim_instantiate_callback (Display *display, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8007 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8008 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8010 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8011 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8012 return;
8014 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8016 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8017 as they have no XIC. */
8018 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8020 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8022 BLOCK_INPUT;
8023 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8025 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8027 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
8028 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8029 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8031 create_frame_xic (f);
8032 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8033 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8034 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8036 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8037 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8042 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8046 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8049 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8050 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8051 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8052 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8054 static void
8055 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8057 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8058 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8059 if (use_xim)
8061 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8062 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
8063 int len;
8065 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
8066 dpyinfo->xim_callback_data = xim_inst;
8067 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8068 len = strlen (resource_name);
8069 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8070 memcpy (xim_inst->resource_name, resource_name, len + 1);
8071 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8072 resource_name, emacs_class,
8073 xim_instantiate_callback,
8074 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8075 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8076 least, hence the configure test. */
8077 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8078 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8079 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8080 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8082 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8086 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8088 static void
8089 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
8091 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8092 if (use_xim)
8094 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8095 if (dpyinfo->display)
8096 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8097 NULL, emacs_class,
8098 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8099 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data->resource_name);
8100 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data);
8101 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8102 if (dpyinfo->display)
8103 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8104 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8105 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8107 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8110 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8114 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8115 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8117 static void
8118 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame *f)
8120 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8122 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8123 is already for the top-left corner. */
8124 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8125 return;
8127 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8128 position that fits on the screen. */
8129 if (flags & XNegative)
8130 f->left_pos = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8131 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos;
8134 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8136 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8137 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8138 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8140 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8141 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8142 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8143 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8144 is right, though.
8146 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8147 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8149 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8150 #endif
8152 if (flags & YNegative)
8153 f->top_pos = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8154 - height + f->top_pos;
8157 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8158 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8159 so the flags should correspond. */
8160 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8163 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8164 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8165 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8166 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8167 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8169 void
8170 x_set_offset (struct frame *f, register int xoff, register int yoff, int change_gravity)
8172 int modified_top, modified_left;
8174 if (change_gravity > 0)
8176 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8177 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8179 f->top_pos = yoff;
8180 f->left_pos = xoff;
8181 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8182 if (xoff < 0)
8183 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8184 if (yoff < 0)
8185 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8186 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8188 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8190 BLOCK_INPUT;
8191 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8193 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8194 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8196 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8198 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8199 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8200 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8201 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8202 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8205 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8206 modified_left, modified_top);
8208 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8209 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8210 ? 1 : 0);
8212 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8213 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8214 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8215 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8216 of the frame.
8218 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8219 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8220 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8222 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8223 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8224 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8225 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8226 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8227 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8229 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8232 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8233 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8234 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8235 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8236 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8238 static int
8239 wm_supports (struct frame *f, Atom want_atom)
8241 Atom actual_type;
8242 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8243 int i, rc, actual_format;
8244 Window wmcheck_window;
8245 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8246 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8247 long max_len = 65536;
8248 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8249 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8250 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8252 BLOCK_INPUT;
8254 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8255 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8256 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check,
8257 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8258 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8259 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8261 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8263 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8264 x_uncatch_errors ();
8265 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8266 return 0;
8269 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8270 XFree (tmp_data);
8272 /* Check if window exists. */
8273 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8274 x_sync (f);
8275 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8277 x_uncatch_errors ();
8278 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8279 return 0;
8282 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8284 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8285 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8286 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8287 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8288 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8289 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8291 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8292 tmp_data = NULL;
8293 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8294 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported,
8295 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8296 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8297 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8299 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8301 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8302 x_uncatch_errors ();
8303 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8304 return 0;
8307 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8308 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8309 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8312 rc = 0;
8314 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8315 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8317 x_uncatch_errors ();
8318 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8320 return rc;
8323 static void
8324 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame, int add, Atom atom, Atom value)
8326 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame));
8328 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8329 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8330 make_number (32),
8331 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
8332 Fcons
8333 (make_number (add ? 1 : 0),
8334 Fcons
8335 (make_fixnum_or_float (atom),
8336 value != 0
8337 ? Fcons (make_fixnum_or_float (value), Qnil)
8338 : Qnil)));
8341 void
8342 x_set_sticky (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object new_value, Lisp_Object old_value)
8344 Lisp_Object frame;
8345 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8347 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8349 set_wm_state (frame, NILP (new_value) ? 0 : 1,
8350 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky, None);
8353 /* Return the current _NET_WM_STATE.
8354 SIZE_STATE is set to one of the FULLSCREEN_* values.
8355 STICKY is set to 1 if the sticky state is set, 0 if not. */
8357 static void
8358 get_current_wm_state (struct frame *f,
8359 Window window,
8360 int *size_state,
8361 int *sticky)
8363 Atom actual_type;
8364 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8365 int i, rc, actual_format;
8366 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8367 long max_len = 65536;
8368 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8369 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8370 Atom target_type = XA_ATOM;
8372 *sticky = 0;
8373 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8375 BLOCK_INPUT;
8376 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8377 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, window, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8378 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8379 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8380 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8382 if (rc != Success || actual_type != target_type || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8384 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8385 x_uncatch_errors ();
8386 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8387 return;
8390 x_uncatch_errors ();
8392 for (i = 0; i < actual_size; ++i)
8394 Atom a = ((Atom*)tmp_data)[i];
8395 if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
8397 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8398 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8399 else
8400 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_WIDTH;
8402 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
8404 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
8405 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8406 else
8407 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT;
8409 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen)
8410 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_BOTH;
8411 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
8412 *sticky = 1;
8415 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8416 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8419 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8421 static int
8422 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8424 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8425 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state);
8426 int cur, dummy;
8428 get_current_wm_state (f, FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &cur, &dummy);
8430 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8431 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8432 if (!have_net_atom)
8433 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen);
8435 if (have_net_atom && cur != f->want_fullscreen)
8437 Lisp_Object frame;
8439 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8441 /* Keep number of calls to set_wm_state as low as possible.
8442 Some window managers, or possible Gtk+, hangs when too many
8443 are sent at once. */
8444 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8446 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8447 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
8448 || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8449 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8450 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8451 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8452 break;
8453 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8454 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
8455 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8456 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8457 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8458 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8459 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz, None);
8460 break;
8461 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8462 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
8463 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8464 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8465 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz);
8466 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8467 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert, None);
8468 break;
8469 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8470 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8471 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8472 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8473 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8474 break;
8475 case FULLSCREEN_NONE:
8476 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8477 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8478 else
8479 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8480 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8483 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8487 return have_net_atom;
8490 static void
8491 XTfullscreen_hook (FRAME_PTR f)
8493 if (f->async_visible)
8495 BLOCK_INPUT;
8496 x_check_fullscreen (f);
8497 x_sync (f);
8498 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8503 static void
8504 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *f, XPropertyEvent *event)
8506 int value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8507 Lisp_Object lval;
8508 int sticky = 0;
8510 get_current_wm_state (f, event->window, &value, &sticky);
8511 lval = Qnil;
8512 switch (value)
8514 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8515 lval = Qfullwidth;
8516 break;
8517 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8518 lval = Qfullheight;
8519 break;
8520 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8521 lval = Qfullboth;
8522 break;
8523 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8524 lval = Qmaximized;
8525 break;
8528 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
8529 store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil);
8532 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8533 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8534 static void
8535 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8537 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8538 return;
8540 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8541 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
8543 /* Setting fullscreen to nil doesn't do anything. We could save the
8544 last non-fullscreen size and restore it, but it seems like a
8545 lot of work for this unusual case (no window manager running). */
8547 if (f->want_fullscreen != FULLSCREEN_NONE)
8549 int width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8550 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8552 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8554 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
8555 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8556 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8557 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8558 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8559 break;
8560 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8561 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8562 break;
8563 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8564 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8567 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8568 width, height);
8572 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8573 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8574 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8575 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8576 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8577 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8578 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8580 static void
8581 x_check_expected_move (struct frame *f, int expected_left, int expected_top)
8583 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8585 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8586 window manager window around the frame. */
8588 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8590 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
8592 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8594 int adjusted_left;
8595 int adjusted_top;
8597 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8598 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
8599 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
8601 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8603 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8604 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8606 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8607 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
8609 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
8611 else
8612 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8613 frame's position. */
8615 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8619 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8620 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8621 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8622 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8623 of an exact comparison. */
8625 static void
8626 x_sync_with_move (struct frame *f, int left, int top, int fuzzy)
8628 int count = 0;
8630 while (count++ < 50)
8632 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8634 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8635 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8636 loop. */
8638 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8639 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8641 if (fuzzy)
8643 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8644 pixels. */
8646 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
8647 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
8648 return;
8650 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
8651 return;
8654 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8655 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8657 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
8661 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
8662 void
8663 x_wait_for_event (struct frame *f, int eventtype)
8665 int level = interrupt_input_blocked;
8667 SELECT_TYPE fds;
8668 EMACS_TIME tmo, tmo_at, time_now;
8669 int fd = ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8671 pending_event_wait.f = f;
8672 pending_event_wait.eventtype = eventtype;
8674 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticable.
8675 Maybe it should be configurable. */
8676 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (tmo, 0, 100000);
8677 EMACS_GET_TIME (tmo_at);
8678 EMACS_ADD_TIME (tmo_at, tmo_at, tmo);
8680 while (pending_event_wait.eventtype)
8682 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
8683 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8684 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
8685 BLOCK_INPUT;
8686 interrupt_input_blocked = level;
8688 FD_ZERO (&fds);
8689 FD_SET (fd, &fds);
8691 EMACS_GET_TIME (time_now);
8692 EMACS_SUB_TIME (tmo, tmo_at, time_now);
8694 if (EMACS_TIME_NEG_P (tmo) || select (fd+1, &fds, NULL, NULL, &tmo) == 0)
8695 break; /* Timeout */
8697 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
8698 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
8702 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8703 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8704 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8705 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8707 static void
8708 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8710 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8712 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8713 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8714 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8716 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
8718 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8720 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols)
8721 + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f);
8722 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows)
8723 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8725 if (change_gravity) f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8726 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8727 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8728 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8731 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8732 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8733 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8734 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8735 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8737 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8738 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8739 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8740 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8742 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8743 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8744 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8745 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8746 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8748 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8749 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8751 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
8752 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
8753 for the ConfigureNotify. */
8754 if (f->async_visible)
8755 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify);
8756 else
8758 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8759 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8760 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8761 x_sync (f);
8766 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8767 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8768 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8769 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8771 void
8772 x_set_window_size (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8774 BLOCK_INPUT;
8776 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8778 int r, c;
8780 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
8781 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
8782 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/cols to
8783 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
8784 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
8785 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
8786 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
8787 int pixelh = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8788 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8789 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
8790 is however. */
8791 pixelh -= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8792 #endif
8793 r = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, pixelh);
8794 /* Update f->scroll_bar_actual_width because it is used in
8795 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS. */
8796 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8797 = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8798 c = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f));
8799 change_frame_size (f, r, c, 0, 1, 0);
8802 #ifdef USE_GTK
8803 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8804 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8805 else
8806 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8807 #else /* not USE_GTK */
8809 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8811 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8813 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8814 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8816 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8817 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8818 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8819 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8820 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8822 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8825 /* Mouse warping. */
8827 void
8828 x_set_mouse_position (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
8830 int pix_x, pix_y;
8832 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8833 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8835 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8836 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8838 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8839 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8841 BLOCK_INPUT;
8843 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8844 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8845 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8848 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8850 void
8851 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame *f, int pix_x, int pix_y)
8853 BLOCK_INPUT;
8855 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8856 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8857 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8860 /* Raise frame F. */
8862 void
8863 x_raise_frame (struct frame *f)
8865 BLOCK_INPUT;
8866 if (f->async_visible)
8867 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8869 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8870 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8873 /* Lower frame F. */
8875 void
8876 x_lower_frame (struct frame *f)
8878 if (f->async_visible)
8880 BLOCK_INPUT;
8881 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8882 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8883 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8887 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
8889 void
8890 x_ewmh_activate_frame (FRAME_PTR f)
8892 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8893 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
8895 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8896 if (f->async_visible && wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window))
8898 Lisp_Object frame;
8899 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8900 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8901 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window,
8902 make_number (32),
8903 Fcons (make_number (1),
8904 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time),
8905 Qnil)));
8909 static void
8910 XTframe_raise_lower (FRAME_PTR f, int raise_flag)
8912 if (raise_flag)
8913 x_raise_frame (f);
8914 else
8915 x_lower_frame (f);
8918 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8920 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK
8922 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8924 #define XEMBED_VERSION 0
8926 static void
8927 xembed_set_info (struct frame *f, enum xembed_info flags)
8929 unsigned long data[2];
8930 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8932 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
8933 data[1] = flags;
8935 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8936 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO, dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO,
8937 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
8939 #endif /* defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK */
8941 static void
8942 xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time t, enum xembed_message msg,
8943 long int detail, long int data1, long int data2)
8945 XEvent event;
8947 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
8948 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
8949 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
8950 event.xclient.format = 32;
8951 event.xclient.data.l[0] = t;
8952 event.xclient.data.l[1] = msg;
8953 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
8954 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
8955 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
8957 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
8958 False, NoEventMask, &event);
8959 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8962 /* Change of visibility. */
8964 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
8965 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
8966 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
8967 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
8968 but it will become visible later when the window manager
8969 finishes with it. */
8971 void
8972 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame *f)
8974 Lisp_Object type;
8975 int original_top, original_left;
8976 int retry_count = 2;
8978 retry:
8980 BLOCK_INPUT;
8982 type = x_icon_type (f);
8983 if (!NILP (type))
8984 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8986 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8988 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
8989 call x_set_offset a second time
8990 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
8991 before the window gets really visible. */
8992 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8993 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
8994 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
8995 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8997 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
8999 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9000 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
9001 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9002 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9003 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9004 else
9006 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9007 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9009 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9010 #ifdef USE_GTK
9011 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9012 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9013 #else
9014 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9015 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9016 else
9017 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9018 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9019 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9022 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9024 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9025 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9026 so that incoming events are handled. */
9028 Lisp_Object frame;
9029 int count;
9030 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9031 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9032 will set it when they are handled. */
9033 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
9035 original_left = f->left_pos;
9036 original_top = f->top_pos;
9038 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9039 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9041 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9043 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9044 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9045 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9046 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9048 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9049 because the window manager may choose the position
9050 and we don't want to override it. */
9052 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9053 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9054 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9055 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
9056 && previously_visible)
9058 Drawable rootw;
9059 int x, y;
9060 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
9062 BLOCK_INPUT;
9064 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9065 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9066 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9067 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9068 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9069 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9070 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9071 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9072 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
9074 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
9075 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9076 original_left, original_top);
9078 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9081 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9083 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9084 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9085 MapNotify at all.. */
9086 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9087 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9089 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9090 x_sync (f);
9092 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9093 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9094 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9095 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9096 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9097 probably a bug. */
9098 if (input_polling_used ())
9100 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9101 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9102 handler reset it. */
9103 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9104 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9105 poll_for_input_1 ();
9106 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9109 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9110 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9113 /* 2000-09-28: In
9115 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9116 (iconify-frame f)
9117 (raise-frame f))
9119 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9120 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9121 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9122 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9124 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count > 0)
9125 goto retry;
9129 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9131 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9133 void
9134 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame *f)
9136 Window window;
9138 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9139 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9141 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9142 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9143 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9145 BLOCK_INPUT;
9147 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9148 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9149 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9150 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9151 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9152 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9154 #ifdef USE_GTK
9155 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9156 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9157 else
9158 #else
9159 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9160 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
9161 else
9162 #endif
9165 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9166 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9168 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9169 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9173 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9174 just by the event that we get from the server.
9175 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9176 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9177 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9178 f->visible = 0;
9179 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
9180 f->async_visible = 0;
9181 f->async_iconified = 0;
9183 x_sync (f);
9185 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9188 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9190 void
9191 x_iconify_frame (struct frame *f)
9193 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9194 int result;
9195 #endif
9196 Lisp_Object type;
9198 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9199 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9200 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9202 if (f->async_iconified)
9203 return;
9205 BLOCK_INPUT;
9207 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9209 type = x_icon_type (f);
9210 if (!NILP (type))
9211 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9213 #ifdef USE_GTK
9214 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9216 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9217 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9219 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9220 f->iconified = 1;
9221 f->visible = 1;
9222 f->async_iconified = 1;
9223 f->async_visible = 0;
9224 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9225 return;
9227 #endif
9229 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9231 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9233 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9234 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9235 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9236 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9237 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9238 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9239 so we have to record it here. */
9240 f->iconified = 1;
9241 f->visible = 1;
9242 f->async_iconified = 1;
9243 f->async_visible = 0;
9244 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9245 return;
9248 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9249 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9250 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9251 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9253 if (!result)
9254 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9256 f->async_iconified = 1;
9257 f->async_visible = 0;
9260 BLOCK_INPUT;
9261 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9262 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9263 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9265 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9266 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9267 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9268 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9269 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9270 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9272 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9273 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9275 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9276 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9278 XEvent msg;
9280 msg.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9281 msg.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9282 msg.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9283 msg.xclient.format = 32;
9284 msg.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9286 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9287 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9288 False,
9289 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9290 &msg))
9292 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9293 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9297 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9298 IconicState. */
9299 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9301 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9303 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9304 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9307 f->async_iconified = 1;
9308 f->async_visible = 0;
9310 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9311 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9312 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9316 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9318 void
9319 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame *f)
9321 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9322 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9323 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9324 Lisp_Object bar;
9325 struct scroll_bar *b;
9326 #endif
9328 BLOCK_INPUT;
9330 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9331 commands to the X server. */
9332 if (dpyinfo->display)
9334 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9335 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9336 face. */
9337 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9338 free_frame_faces (f);
9340 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9341 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9343 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9344 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9345 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9346 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9347 toolkit scroll bars. */
9348 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9350 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9351 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9353 #endif
9355 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9356 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9357 free_frame_xic (f);
9358 #endif
9360 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9361 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9363 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9364 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9366 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9367 we are using a toolkit. */
9368 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9369 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9371 free_frame_menubar (f);
9372 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9374 #ifdef USE_GTK
9375 xg_free_frame_widgets (f);
9376 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9378 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9379 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9380 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9382 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9383 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9384 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9385 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9386 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9387 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9389 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9390 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9391 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9392 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9393 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9394 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9395 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9396 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9397 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9398 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9399 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9400 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9401 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9402 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9403 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9405 x_free_gcs (f);
9406 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9409 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9410 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9411 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9413 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9414 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9415 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9416 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9417 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9418 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9420 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9422 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9423 = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9424 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9425 = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9426 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9427 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9428 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9431 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9435 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9437 void
9438 x_destroy_window (struct frame *f)
9440 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9442 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9443 commands to the X server. */
9444 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9445 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9447 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9451 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9453 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9454 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9455 that the window now has.
9456 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9457 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9458 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9460 #ifndef USE_GTK
9461 void
9462 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame *f, long flags, int user_position)
9464 XSizeHints size_hints;
9465 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9467 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9468 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9470 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9471 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9473 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9474 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9476 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9477 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9478 size_hints.max_width = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9479 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9480 size_hints.max_height = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9481 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9483 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
9485 int base_width, base_height;
9486 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9488 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9489 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9491 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9493 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9494 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9495 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9496 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9497 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9499 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9500 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9501 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9503 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9504 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9505 size_hints.base_height = base_height + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
9506 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9507 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9510 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9511 if (flags)
9513 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9514 goto no_read;
9518 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9519 long supplied_return;
9520 int value;
9522 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9523 &supplied_return);
9525 if (flags)
9526 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9527 else
9529 if (value == 0)
9530 hints.flags = 0;
9531 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9532 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9533 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9534 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9535 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9536 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9537 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9538 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9542 no_read:
9544 #ifdef PWinGravity
9545 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9546 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9548 if (user_position)
9550 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9551 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9553 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9555 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9557 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9559 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9561 void
9562 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *f, int state)
9564 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9565 Arg al[1];
9567 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9568 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9569 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9570 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9572 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9573 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9575 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9576 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9579 void
9580 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *f, int pixmap_id)
9582 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9584 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
9585 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9586 #endif
9588 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9590 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9591 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9592 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9593 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9595 else
9597 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
9598 pixmap. */
9599 return;
9603 #ifdef USE_GTK
9605 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9606 return;
9609 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9612 Arg al[1];
9613 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9614 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9615 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9616 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9619 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9621 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9622 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9624 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9627 void
9628 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame *f, int icon_x, int icon_y)
9630 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9632 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9633 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9634 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9636 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9640 /***********************************************************************
9641 Fonts
9642 ***********************************************************************/
9644 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
9646 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9647 font table. */
9649 static void
9650 x_check_font (struct frame *f, struct font *font)
9652 Lisp_Object frame;
9654 xassert (font != NULL && ! NILP (font->props[FONT_TYPE_INDEX]));
9655 if (font->driver->check)
9656 xassert (font->driver->check (f, font) == 0);
9659 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9662 /***********************************************************************
9663 Initialization
9664 ***********************************************************************/
9666 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9667 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9668 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9669 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9671 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9672 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9673 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9675 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9676 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9677 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9678 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9679 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9680 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9681 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
9684 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
9686 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
9688 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9690 static int x_initialized;
9692 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9693 the screen number from the server number. */
9694 static int
9695 same_x_server (const char *name1, const char *name2)
9697 int seen_colon = 0;
9698 const char *system_name = SSDATA (Vsystem_name);
9699 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
9700 int length_until_period = 0;
9702 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
9703 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
9704 length_until_period++;
9706 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
9707 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
9708 name1 += 4;
9709 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
9710 name2 += 4;
9711 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
9712 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
9713 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
9714 name1 += system_name_length;
9715 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
9716 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
9717 name2 += system_name_length;
9718 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
9719 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
9720 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
9721 name1 += length_until_period;
9722 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
9723 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
9724 name2 += length_until_period;
9726 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
9728 if (*name1 == ':')
9729 seen_colon++;
9730 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
9731 return 1;
9733 return (seen_colon
9734 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
9735 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
9738 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
9739 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
9740 to 5. */
9741 static void
9742 get_bits_and_offset (long unsigned int mask, int *bits, int *offset)
9744 int nr = 0;
9745 int off = 0;
9747 while (!(mask & 1))
9749 off++;
9750 mask >>= 1;
9753 while (mask & 1)
9755 nr++;
9756 mask >>= 1;
9759 *offset = off;
9760 *bits = nr;
9763 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
9764 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
9767 x_display_ok (const char *display)
9769 int dpy_ok = 1;
9770 Display *dpy;
9772 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
9773 if (dpy)
9774 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
9775 else
9776 dpy_ok = 0;
9777 return dpy_ok;
9780 #ifdef USE_GTK
9781 static void
9782 my_log_handler (const gchar *log_domain, GLogLevelFlags log_level,
9783 const gchar *msg, gpointer user_data)
9785 if (!strstr (msg, "g_set_prgname"))
9786 fprintf (stderr, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain, msg);
9788 #endif
9790 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
9791 the structure that describes the open display.
9792 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
9794 struct x_display_info *
9795 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name, char *xrm_option, char *resource_name)
9797 int connection;
9798 Display *dpy;
9799 struct terminal *terminal;
9800 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9801 XrmDatabase xrdb;
9802 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo;
9804 BLOCK_INPUT;
9806 if (!x_initialized)
9808 x_initialize ();
9809 ++x_initialized;
9812 if (! x_display_ok (SSDATA (display_name)))
9813 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SSDATA (display_name));
9815 #ifdef USE_GTK
9817 #define NUM_ARGV 10
9818 int argc;
9819 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
9820 char **argv2 = argv;
9821 guint id;
9823 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
9825 xg_display_open (SSDATA (display_name), &dpy);
9827 else
9829 static char display_opt[] = "--display";
9830 static char name_opt[] = "--name";
9832 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
9833 argv[argc] = 0;
9835 argc = 0;
9836 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
9838 if (! NILP (display_name))
9840 argv[argc++] = display_opt;
9841 argv[argc++] = SSDATA (display_name);
9844 argv[argc++] = name_opt;
9845 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
9847 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9849 /* Emacs can only handle core input events, so make sure
9850 Gtk doesn't use Xinput or Xinput2 extensions. */
9852 static char fix_events[] = "GDK_CORE_DEVICE_EVENTS=1";
9853 putenv (fix_events);
9856 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
9857 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
9858 id = g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING | G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
9859 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION, my_log_handler, NULL);
9860 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
9861 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id);
9863 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
9864 fixup_locale ();
9865 xg_initialize ();
9867 dpy = DEFAULT_GDK_DISPLAY ();
9869 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
9870 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
9872 #if GTK_MAJOR_VERSION <= 2 && GTK_MINOR_VERSION <= 90
9873 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
9875 const char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
9876 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
9878 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
9879 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
9881 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
9882 gtk_rc_parse (SSDATA (abs_file));
9884 #endif
9886 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
9887 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
9890 #else /* not USE_GTK */
9891 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9892 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
9893 errors with X11R5:
9894 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
9895 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
9896 So let's not use it until R6. */
9897 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9898 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
9899 #endif
9902 int argc = 0;
9903 char *argv[3];
9905 argv[0] = "";
9906 argc = 1;
9907 if (xrm_option)
9909 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
9910 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
9912 turn_on_atimers (0);
9913 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SSDATA (display_name),
9914 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
9915 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
9916 &argc, argv);
9917 turn_on_atimers (1);
9919 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9920 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
9921 fixup_locale ();
9922 #endif
9925 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9926 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9927 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SSDATA (display_name));
9928 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9929 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
9931 /* Detect failure. */
9932 if (dpy == 0)
9934 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9935 return 0;
9938 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
9940 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
9941 memset (dpyinfo, 0, sizeof *dpyinfo);
9942 hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9944 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
9947 struct x_display_info *share;
9948 Lisp_Object tail;
9950 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
9951 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
9952 if (same_x_server (SSDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
9953 SSDATA (display_name)))
9954 break;
9955 if (share)
9956 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
9957 else
9959 terminal->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
9960 init_kboard (terminal->kboard);
9961 KVAR (terminal->kboard, Vwindow_system) = Qx;
9963 /* Add the keyboard to the list before running Lisp code (via
9964 Qvendor_specific_keysyms below), since these are not traced
9965 via terminals but only through all_kboards. */
9966 terminal->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
9967 all_kboards = terminal->kboard;
9969 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
9971 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
9973 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
9974 list of terminals. */
9975 struct gcpro gcpro1;
9976 Lisp_Object gcpro_term;
9977 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term, terminal);
9978 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term);
9980 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
9981 terminal_list = terminal->next_terminal;
9982 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9983 KVAR (terminal->kboard, Vsystem_key_alist)
9984 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
9985 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string);
9986 BLOCK_INPUT;
9987 terminal->next_terminal = terminal_list;
9988 terminal_list = terminal;
9989 UNGCPRO;
9992 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
9993 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
9994 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
9995 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
9996 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
9998 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
10001 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10002 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10003 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10005 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10006 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10007 x_display_name_list);
10008 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10010 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10012 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
10013 terminal->name = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name) + 1);
10014 strncpy (terminal->name, SSDATA (display_name), SBYTES (display_name));
10015 terminal->name[SBYTES (display_name)] = 0;
10017 #if 0
10018 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10019 #endif /* ! 0 */
10021 dpyinfo->x_id_name
10022 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10023 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
10024 + 2);
10025 sprintf (dpyinfo->x_id_name, "%s@%s",
10026 SSDATA (Vinvocation_name), SSDATA (Vsystem_name));
10028 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10029 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10031 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10032 #ifdef USE_GTK
10033 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10034 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10035 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10037 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10038 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10040 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10041 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10042 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10043 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10044 #else
10045 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10046 #endif
10047 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10048 all versions. */
10049 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10051 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10052 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10053 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10054 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10055 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10056 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10057 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10058 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10059 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10060 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10061 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10062 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10063 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10064 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10065 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10066 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10067 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10068 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10069 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10070 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10071 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10072 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10073 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10074 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10075 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10076 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10077 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10078 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10080 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10081 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10082 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10084 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10086 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10087 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10088 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10089 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10090 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10091 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10094 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10095 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10097 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10099 Lisp_Object value;
10100 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10101 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10102 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10103 Qnil, Qnil);
10104 if (STRINGP (value)
10105 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10106 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10107 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10110 else
10111 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10112 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10114 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
10116 /* If we are using Xft, check dpi value in X resources.
10117 It is better we use it as well, since Xft will use it, as will all
10118 Gnome applications. If our real DPI is smaller or larger than the
10119 one Xft uses, our font will look smaller or larger than other
10120 for other applications, even if it is the same font name (monospace-10
10121 for example). */
10122 char *v = XGetDefault (dpyinfo->display, "Xft", "dpi");
10123 double d;
10124 if (v != NULL && sscanf (v, "%lf", &d) == 1)
10125 dpyinfo->resy = dpyinfo->resx = d;
10127 #endif
10129 if (dpyinfo->resy < 1)
10131 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10132 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10133 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10134 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10135 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10136 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10137 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10138 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10139 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10143 const struct
10145 const char *name;
10146 Atom *atom;
10147 } atom_refs[] = {
10148 { "WM_PROTOCOLS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols },
10149 { "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus },
10150 { "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself },
10151 { "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window },
10152 { "WM_CHANGE_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state },
10153 { "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied },
10154 { "WM_MOVED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved },
10155 { "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader },
10156 { "Editres", &dpyinfo->Xatom_editres },
10157 { "CLIPBOARD", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD },
10158 { "TIMESTAMP", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP },
10159 { "TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT },
10160 { "COMPOUND_TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT },
10161 { "UTF8_STRING", &dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING },
10162 { "DELETE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE },
10163 { "MULTIPLE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE },
10164 { "INCR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR },
10165 { "_EMACS_TMP_", &dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP },
10166 { "TARGETS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS },
10167 { "NULL", &dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL },
10168 { "ATOM_PAIR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR },
10169 { "_XEMBED_INFO", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO },
10170 /* For properties of font. */
10171 { "PIXEL_SIZE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE },
10172 { "AVERAGE_WIDTH", &dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH },
10173 { "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET },
10174 { "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE },
10175 { "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT },
10176 /* Ghostscript support. */
10177 { "DONE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE },
10178 { "PAGE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE },
10179 { "SCROLLBAR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar },
10180 { "_XEMBED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED },
10181 /* EWMH */
10182 { "_NET_WM_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state },
10183 { "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen },
10184 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ",
10185 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz },
10186 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT",
10187 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert },
10188 { "_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky },
10189 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type },
10190 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP",
10191 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip },
10192 { "_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_icon_name },
10193 { "_NET_WM_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_name },
10194 { "_NET_SUPPORTED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported },
10195 { "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check },
10196 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity },
10197 { "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window },
10198 { "_NET_FRAME_EXTENTS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_frame_extents },
10199 /* Session management */
10200 { "SM_CLIENT_ID", &dpyinfo->Xatom_SM_CLIENT_ID },
10201 { "_XSETTINGS_SETTINGS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_prop },
10202 { "MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_mgr },
10205 int i;
10206 const int atom_count = sizeof (atom_refs) / sizeof (atom_refs[0]);
10207 /* 1 for _XSETTINGS_SN */
10208 const int total_atom_count = 1 + atom_count;
10209 Atom *atoms_return = xmalloc (sizeof (Atom) * total_atom_count);
10210 char **atom_names = xmalloc (sizeof (char *) * total_atom_count);
10211 char xsettings_atom_name[64];
10213 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10214 atom_names[i] = (char *) atom_refs[i].name;
10216 /* Build _XSETTINGS_SN atom name */
10217 snprintf (xsettings_atom_name, sizeof (xsettings_atom_name),
10218 "_XSETTINGS_S%d", XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen));
10219 atom_names[i] = xsettings_atom_name;
10221 XInternAtoms (dpyinfo->display, atom_names, total_atom_count,
10222 False, atoms_return);
10224 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10225 *atom_refs[i].atom = atoms_return[i];
10227 /* Manual copy of last atom */
10228 dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_sel = atoms_return[i];
10230 xfree (atom_names);
10231 xfree (atoms_return);
10234 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
10235 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
10236 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof (*dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms)
10237 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
10239 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
10240 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
10241 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
10243 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10244 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10247 dpyinfo->gray
10248 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10249 gray_bitmap_bits,
10250 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
10251 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
10254 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10255 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10256 #endif
10258 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo);
10260 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10261 if (connection != 0)
10262 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10264 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10265 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10266 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10268 #ifdef SIGIO
10269 if (interrupt_input)
10270 init_sigio (connection);
10271 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10273 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10275 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10276 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10277 Font font;
10279 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10280 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10281 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10282 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10283 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10284 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10285 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10286 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10287 abort ();
10288 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10289 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10290 x_uncatch_errors ();
10292 #endif
10294 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10295 for debugging X code. */
10297 Lisp_Object value;
10298 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10299 build_string ("synchronous"),
10300 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10301 Qnil, Qnil);
10302 if (STRINGP (value)
10303 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10304 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10305 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10309 Lisp_Object value;
10310 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10311 build_string ("useXIM"),
10312 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10313 Qnil, Qnil);
10314 #ifdef USE_XIM
10315 if (STRINGP (value)
10316 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "false")
10317 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "off")))
10318 use_xim = 0;
10319 #else
10320 if (STRINGP (value)
10321 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10322 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10323 use_xim = 1;
10324 #endif
10327 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10328 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
10329 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
10330 tty. */
10331 if (terminal->id == 1)
10332 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10333 #endif
10335 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10337 return dpyinfo;
10340 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
10341 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10343 void
10344 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10346 struct terminal *t;
10348 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
10349 X display. */
10350 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
10351 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
10353 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10354 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
10355 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
10356 x_session_close ();
10357 #endif
10358 delete_terminal (t);
10359 break;
10362 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10364 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10365 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10366 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10367 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10368 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10369 else
10371 Lisp_Object tail;
10373 tail = x_display_name_list;
10374 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10376 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10378 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10379 break;
10381 tail = XCDR (tail);
10385 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10386 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10388 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10389 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10390 else
10392 struct x_display_info *tail;
10394 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10395 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10396 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10399 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10400 xfree (dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms);
10401 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10402 xfree (dpyinfo);
10405 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10407 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10408 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10409 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10410 that slows us down. */
10412 static void
10413 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer *timer)
10415 BLOCK_INPUT;
10416 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
10417 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10419 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10420 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10421 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
10422 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
10424 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10427 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10428 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
10429 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
10430 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
10431 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
10432 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
10433 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
10435 void
10436 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
10438 BLOCK_INPUT;
10439 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
10441 EMACS_TIME interval;
10443 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
10444 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10445 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
10447 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10450 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10453 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10455 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
10457 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10459 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10460 x_produce_glyphs,
10461 x_write_glyphs,
10462 x_insert_glyphs,
10463 x_clear_end_of_line,
10464 x_scroll_run,
10465 x_after_update_window_line,
10466 x_update_window_begin,
10467 x_update_window_end,
10468 x_cursor_to,
10469 x_flush,
10470 #ifdef XFlush
10471 x_flush,
10472 #else
10473 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10474 #endif
10475 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10476 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10477 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10478 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10479 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10480 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10481 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10482 x_draw_glyph_string,
10483 x_define_frame_cursor,
10484 x_clear_frame_area,
10485 x_draw_window_cursor,
10486 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10487 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10491 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
10492 void
10493 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
10495 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
10497 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
10498 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
10499 if (!terminal->name)
10500 return;
10502 BLOCK_INPUT;
10503 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10504 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
10505 X display. */
10506 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10507 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10508 #endif
10510 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
10511 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
10512 if (dpyinfo->display)
10514 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
10515 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
10517 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
10518 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
10519 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
10520 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
10522 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
10523 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
10524 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
10525 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
10526 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
10527 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
10528 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
10529 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
10530 leaks in other situations. */
10531 #if 0
10532 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10533 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, NULL);
10534 #else
10535 dpyinfo->display->db = NULL;
10536 #endif
10537 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
10538 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
10539 closing all the displays. */
10540 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10541 #endif
10543 #ifdef USE_GTK
10544 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
10545 #else
10546 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10547 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10548 #else
10549 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10550 #endif
10551 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
10554 /* Mark as dead. */
10555 dpyinfo->display = NULL;
10556 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
10557 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10560 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
10561 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
10563 static struct terminal *
10564 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10566 struct terminal *terminal;
10568 terminal = create_terminal ();
10570 terminal->type = output_x_window;
10571 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
10572 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
10574 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
10576 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10577 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10578 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10579 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10580 terminal->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook = XTtoggle_invisible_pointer;
10581 terminal->reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10582 terminal->set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10583 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10584 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10585 terminal->set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10586 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10587 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10588 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10589 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10590 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10591 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
10592 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10593 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10594 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10595 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10597 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
10598 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
10600 terminal->rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10601 terminal->scroll_region_ok = 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
10602 terminal->char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10603 terminal->line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
10604 terminal->fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well. */
10605 terminal->memory_below_frame = 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
10606 off the bottom. */
10608 return terminal;
10611 void
10612 x_initialize (void)
10614 baud_rate = 19200;
10616 x_noop_count = 0;
10617 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10618 any_help_event_p = 0;
10619 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10621 #ifdef USE_GTK
10622 current_count = -1;
10623 #endif
10625 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10626 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
10628 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10629 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10631 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10633 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10634 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10635 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10636 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10637 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10638 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10639 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10641 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10642 #endif
10644 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10645 #ifndef USE_GTK
10646 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10647 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10648 #endif
10649 #endif
10651 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
10652 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
10653 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
10655 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10656 original error handler. */
10657 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10658 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10660 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
10662 xgselect_initialize ();
10666 void
10667 syms_of_xterm (void)
10669 x_error_message = NULL;
10671 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10672 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10674 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10675 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10677 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
10678 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern_c_string ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
10680 staticpro (&Qlatin_1);
10681 Qlatin_1 = intern_c_string ("latin-1");
10683 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10684 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10686 #ifdef USE_GTK
10687 xg_default_icon_file = make_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
10688 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file);
10690 Qx_gtk_map_stock = intern_c_string ("x-gtk-map-stock");
10691 staticpro (&Qx_gtk_map_stock);
10692 #endif
10694 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10695 x_use_underline_position_properties,
10696 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10697 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10698 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10699 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
10700 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
10701 sizes. */);
10702 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10704 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
10705 x_underline_at_descent_line,
10706 doc: /* *Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
10707 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
10708 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
10709 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
10710 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
10712 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10713 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10714 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10715 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10716 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10717 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10718 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10719 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10720 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10722 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10723 doc: /* Which toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses, if any.
10724 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use toolkit scroll bars.
10725 With the X Window system, the value is a symbol describing the
10726 X toolkit. Possible values are: gtk, motif, xaw, or xaw3d.
10727 With MS Windows, the value is t. */);
10728 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10729 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10730 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("motif");
10731 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10732 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
10733 #elif USE_GTK
10734 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("gtk");
10735 #else
10736 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw");
10737 #endif
10738 #else
10739 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10740 #endif
10742 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10743 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10745 Qmodifier_value = intern_c_string ("modifier-value");
10746 Qalt = intern_c_string ("alt");
10747 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10748 Qhyper = intern_c_string ("hyper");
10749 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10750 Qmeta = intern_c_string ("meta");
10751 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10752 Qsuper = intern_c_string ("super");
10753 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10755 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", Vx_alt_keysym,
10756 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10757 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10758 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10759 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10760 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10762 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", Vx_hyper_keysym,
10763 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10764 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10765 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10766 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10767 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10769 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", Vx_meta_keysym,
10770 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10771 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10772 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10773 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10774 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10776 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", Vx_super_keysym,
10777 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10778 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10779 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10780 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10781 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10783 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", Vx_keysym_table,
10784 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10785 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10786 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10787 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10788 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10791 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */